• Home
  • Line#
  • Scopes#
  • Navigate#
  • Raw
  • Download
1 /* SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-only */
2 #ifndef __NET_CFG80211_H
3 #define __NET_CFG80211_H
4 /*
5  * 802.11 device and configuration interface
6  *
7  * Copyright 2006-2010	Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net>
8  * Copyright 2013-2014 Intel Mobile Communications GmbH
9  * Copyright 2015-2017	Intel Deutschland GmbH
10  * Copyright (C) 2018-2020 Intel Corporation
11  */
12 
13 #include <linux/netdevice.h>
14 #include <linux/debugfs.h>
15 #include <linux/list.h>
16 #include <linux/bug.h>
17 #include <linux/netlink.h>
18 #include <linux/skbuff.h>
19 #include <linux/nl80211.h>
20 #include <linux/if_ether.h>
21 #include <linux/ieee80211.h>
22 #include <linux/net.h>
23 #include <net/regulatory.h>
24 
25 /**
26  * DOC: Introduction
27  *
28  * cfg80211 is the configuration API for 802.11 devices in Linux. It bridges
29  * userspace and drivers, and offers some utility functionality associated
30  * with 802.11. cfg80211 must, directly or indirectly via mac80211, be used
31  * by all modern wireless drivers in Linux, so that they offer a consistent
32  * API through nl80211. For backward compatibility, cfg80211 also offers
33  * wireless extensions to userspace, but hides them from drivers completely.
34  *
35  * Additionally, cfg80211 contains code to help enforce regulatory spectrum
36  * use restrictions.
37  */
38 
39 
40 /**
41  * DOC: Device registration
42  *
43  * In order for a driver to use cfg80211, it must register the hardware device
44  * with cfg80211. This happens through a number of hardware capability structs
45  * described below.
46  *
47  * The fundamental structure for each device is the 'wiphy', of which each
48  * instance describes a physical wireless device connected to the system. Each
49  * such wiphy can have zero, one, or many virtual interfaces associated with
50  * it, which need to be identified as such by pointing the network interface's
51  * @ieee80211_ptr pointer to a &struct wireless_dev which further describes
52  * the wireless part of the interface, normally this struct is embedded in the
53  * network interface's private data area. Drivers can optionally allow creating
54  * or destroying virtual interfaces on the fly, but without at least one or the
55  * ability to create some the wireless device isn't useful.
56  *
57  * Each wiphy structure contains device capability information, and also has
58  * a pointer to the various operations the driver offers. The definitions and
59  * structures here describe these capabilities in detail.
60  */
61 
62 struct wiphy;
63 
64 /*
65  * wireless hardware capability structures
66  */
67 
68 /**
69  * enum ieee80211_channel_flags - channel flags
70  *
71  * Channel flags set by the regulatory control code.
72  *
73  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED: This channel is disabled.
74  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_IR: do not initiate radiation, this includes
75  *	sending probe requests or beaconing.
76  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_RADAR: Radar detection is required on this channel.
77  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS: extension channel above this channel
78  *	is not permitted.
79  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS: extension channel below this channel
80  *	is not permitted.
81  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_OFDM: OFDM is not allowed on this channel.
82  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_80MHZ: If the driver supports 80 MHz on the band,
83  *	this flag indicates that an 80 MHz channel cannot use this
84  *	channel as the control or any of the secondary channels.
85  *	This may be due to the driver or due to regulatory bandwidth
86  *	restrictions.
87  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_160MHZ: If the driver supports 160 MHz on the band,
88  *	this flag indicates that an 160 MHz channel cannot use this
89  *	channel as the control or any of the secondary channels.
90  *	This may be due to the driver or due to regulatory bandwidth
91  *	restrictions.
92  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_INDOOR_ONLY: see %NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY
93  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_IR_CONCURRENT: see %NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT
94  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_20MHZ: 20 MHz bandwidth is not permitted
95  *	on this channel.
96  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_10MHZ: 10 MHz bandwidth is not permitted
97  *	on this channel.
98  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HE: HE operation is not permitted on this channel.
99  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_1MHZ: 1 MHz bandwidth is permitted
100  *	on this channel.
101  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_2MHZ: 2 MHz bandwidth is permitted
102  *	on this channel.
103  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_4MHZ: 4 MHz bandwidth is permitted
104  *	on this channel.
105  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_8MHZ: 8 MHz bandwidth is permitted
106  *	on this channel.
107  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_16MHZ: 16 MHz bandwidth is permitted
108  *	on this channel.
109  *
110  */
111 enum ieee80211_channel_flags {
112 	IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED		= 1<<0,
113 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_IR		= 1<<1,
114 	/* hole at 1<<2 */
115 	IEEE80211_CHAN_RADAR		= 1<<3,
116 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS	= 1<<4,
117 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS	= 1<<5,
118 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_OFDM		= 1<<6,
119 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_80MHZ		= 1<<7,
120 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_160MHZ	= 1<<8,
121 	IEEE80211_CHAN_INDOOR_ONLY	= 1<<9,
122 	IEEE80211_CHAN_IR_CONCURRENT	= 1<<10,
123 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_20MHZ		= 1<<11,
124 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_10MHZ		= 1<<12,
125 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HE		= 1<<13,
126 	IEEE80211_CHAN_1MHZ		= 1<<14,
127 	IEEE80211_CHAN_2MHZ		= 1<<15,
128 	IEEE80211_CHAN_4MHZ		= 1<<16,
129 	IEEE80211_CHAN_8MHZ		= 1<<17,
130 	IEEE80211_CHAN_16MHZ		= 1<<18,
131 };
132 
133 #define IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40 \
134 	(IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS | IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS)
135 
136 #define IEEE80211_DFS_MIN_CAC_TIME_MS		60000
137 #define IEEE80211_DFS_MIN_NOP_TIME_MS		(30 * 60 * 1000)
138 
139 /**
140  * struct ieee80211_channel - channel definition
141  *
142  * This structure describes a single channel for use
143  * with cfg80211.
144  *
145  * @center_freq: center frequency in MHz
146  * @freq_offset: offset from @center_freq, in KHz
147  * @hw_value: hardware-specific value for the channel
148  * @flags: channel flags from &enum ieee80211_channel_flags.
149  * @orig_flags: channel flags at registration time, used by regulatory
150  *	code to support devices with additional restrictions
151  * @band: band this channel belongs to.
152  * @max_antenna_gain: maximum antenna gain in dBi
153  * @max_power: maximum transmission power (in dBm)
154  * @max_reg_power: maximum regulatory transmission power (in dBm)
155  * @beacon_found: helper to regulatory code to indicate when a beacon
156  *	has been found on this channel. Use regulatory_hint_found_beacon()
157  *	to enable this, this is useful only on 5 GHz band.
158  * @orig_mag: internal use
159  * @orig_mpwr: internal use
160  * @dfs_state: current state of this channel. Only relevant if radar is required
161  *	on this channel.
162  * @dfs_state_entered: timestamp (jiffies) when the dfs state was entered.
163  * @dfs_cac_ms: DFS CAC time in milliseconds, this is valid for DFS channels.
164  */
165 struct ieee80211_channel {
166 	enum nl80211_band band;
167 	u32 center_freq;
168 	u16 freq_offset;
169 	u16 hw_value;
170 	u32 flags;
171 	int max_antenna_gain;
172 	int max_power;
173 	int max_reg_power;
174 	bool beacon_found;
175 	u32 orig_flags;
176 	int orig_mag, orig_mpwr;
177 	enum nl80211_dfs_state dfs_state;
178 	unsigned long dfs_state_entered;
179 	unsigned int dfs_cac_ms;
180 };
181 
182 /**
183  * enum ieee80211_rate_flags - rate flags
184  *
185  * Hardware/specification flags for rates. These are structured
186  * in a way that allows using the same bitrate structure for
187  * different bands/PHY modes.
188  *
189  * @IEEE80211_RATE_SHORT_PREAMBLE: Hardware can send with short
190  *	preamble on this bitrate; only relevant in 2.4GHz band and
191  *	with CCK rates.
192  * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_A: This bitrate is a mandatory rate
193  *	when used with 802.11a (on the 5 GHz band); filled by the
194  *	core code when registering the wiphy.
195  * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_B: This bitrate is a mandatory rate
196  *	when used with 802.11b (on the 2.4 GHz band); filled by the
197  *	core code when registering the wiphy.
198  * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_G: This bitrate is a mandatory rate
199  *	when used with 802.11g (on the 2.4 GHz band); filled by the
200  *	core code when registering the wiphy.
201  * @IEEE80211_RATE_ERP_G: This is an ERP rate in 802.11g mode.
202  * @IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ: Rate can be used in 5 MHz mode
203  * @IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ: Rate can be used in 10 MHz mode
204  */
205 enum ieee80211_rate_flags {
206 	IEEE80211_RATE_SHORT_PREAMBLE	= 1<<0,
207 	IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_A	= 1<<1,
208 	IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_B	= 1<<2,
209 	IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_G	= 1<<3,
210 	IEEE80211_RATE_ERP_G		= 1<<4,
211 	IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ	= 1<<5,
212 	IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ	= 1<<6,
213 };
214 
215 /**
216  * enum ieee80211_bss_type - BSS type filter
217  *
218  * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ESS: Infrastructure BSS
219  * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_PBSS: Personal BSS
220  * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS: Independent BSS
221  * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_MBSS: Mesh BSS
222  * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ANY: Wildcard value for matching any BSS type
223  */
224 enum ieee80211_bss_type {
225 	IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ESS,
226 	IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_PBSS,
227 	IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS,
228 	IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_MBSS,
229 	IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ANY
230 };
231 
232 /**
233  * enum ieee80211_privacy - BSS privacy filter
234  *
235  * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON: privacy bit set
236  * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF: privacy bit clear
237  * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY: Wildcard value for matching any privacy setting
238  */
239 enum ieee80211_privacy {
240 	IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON,
241 	IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF,
242 	IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY
243 };
244 
245 #define IEEE80211_PRIVACY(x)	\
246 	((x) ? IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON : IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF)
247 
248 /**
249  * struct ieee80211_rate - bitrate definition
250  *
251  * This structure describes a bitrate that an 802.11 PHY can
252  * operate with. The two values @hw_value and @hw_value_short
253  * are only for driver use when pointers to this structure are
254  * passed around.
255  *
256  * @flags: rate-specific flags
257  * @bitrate: bitrate in units of 100 Kbps
258  * @hw_value: driver/hardware value for this rate
259  * @hw_value_short: driver/hardware value for this rate when
260  *	short preamble is used
261  */
262 struct ieee80211_rate {
263 	u32 flags;
264 	u16 bitrate;
265 	u16 hw_value, hw_value_short;
266 };
267 
268 /**
269  * struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd - AP settings for spatial reuse
270  *
271  * @enable: is the feature enabled.
272  * @sr_ctrl: The SR Control field of SRP element.
273  * @non_srg_max_offset: non-SRG maximum tx power offset
274  * @min_offset: minimal tx power offset an associated station shall use
275  * @max_offset: maximum tx power offset an associated station shall use
276  * @bss_color_bitmap: bitmap that indicates the BSS color values used by
277  *	members of the SRG
278  * @partial_bssid_bitmap: bitmap that indicates the partial BSSID values
279  *	used by members of the SRG
280  */
281 struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd {
282 	bool enable;
283 	u8 sr_ctrl;
284 	u8 non_srg_max_offset;
285 	u8 min_offset;
286 	u8 max_offset;
287 	u8 bss_color_bitmap[8];
288 	u8 partial_bssid_bitmap[8];
289 };
290 
291 /**
292  * struct cfg80211_he_bss_color - AP settings for BSS coloring
293  *
294  * @color: the current color.
295  * @enabled: HE BSS color is used
296  * @partial: define the AID equation.
297  */
298 struct cfg80211_he_bss_color {
299 	u8 color;
300 	bool enabled;
301 	bool partial;
302 };
303 
304 /**
305  * struct ieee80211_he_bss_color - AP settings for BSS coloring
306  *
307  * @color: the current color.
308  * @disabled: is the feature disabled.
309  * @partial: define the AID equation.
310  */
311 struct ieee80211_he_bss_color {
312 	u8 color;
313 	bool disabled;
314 	bool partial;
315 };
316 
317 /**
318  * struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap - STA's HT capabilities
319  *
320  * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
321  * to describe 802.11n HT capabilities for an STA.
322  *
323  * @ht_supported: is HT supported by the STA
324  * @cap: HT capabilities map as described in 802.11n spec
325  * @ampdu_factor: Maximum A-MPDU length factor
326  * @ampdu_density: Minimum A-MPDU spacing
327  * @mcs: Supported MCS rates
328  */
329 struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap {
330 	u16 cap; /* use IEEE80211_HT_CAP_ */
331 	bool ht_supported;
332 	u8 ampdu_factor;
333 	u8 ampdu_density;
334 	struct ieee80211_mcs_info mcs;
335 };
336 
337 /**
338  * struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap - STA's VHT capabilities
339  *
340  * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
341  * to describe 802.11ac VHT capabilities for an STA.
342  *
343  * @vht_supported: is VHT supported by the STA
344  * @cap: VHT capabilities map as described in 802.11ac spec
345  * @vht_mcs: Supported VHT MCS rates
346  */
347 struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap {
348 	bool vht_supported;
349 	u32 cap; /* use IEEE80211_VHT_CAP_ */
350 	struct ieee80211_vht_mcs_info vht_mcs;
351 };
352 
353 #define IEEE80211_HE_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN		25
354 
355 /**
356  * struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap - STA's HE capabilities
357  *
358  * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
359  * to describe 802.11ax HE capabilities for a STA.
360  *
361  * @has_he: true iff HE data is valid.
362  * @he_cap_elem: Fixed portion of the HE capabilities element.
363  * @he_mcs_nss_supp: The supported NSS/MCS combinations.
364  * @ppe_thres: Holds the PPE Thresholds data.
365  */
366 struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap {
367 	bool has_he;
368 	struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem he_cap_elem;
369 	struct ieee80211_he_mcs_nss_supp he_mcs_nss_supp;
370 	u8 ppe_thres[IEEE80211_HE_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN];
371 };
372 
373 /**
374  * struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data
375  *
376  * This structure encapsulates sband data that is relevant for the
377  * interface types defined in @types_mask.  Each type in the
378  * @types_mask must be unique across all instances of iftype_data.
379  *
380  * @types_mask: interface types mask
381  * @he_cap: holds the HE capabilities
382  * @he_6ghz_capa: HE 6 GHz capabilities, must be filled in for a
383  *	6 GHz band channel (and 0 may be valid value).
384  */
385 struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data {
386 	u16 types_mask;
387 	struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap he_cap;
388 	struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa he_6ghz_capa;
389 };
390 
391 /**
392  * enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config - allowed channel bandwidth configurations
393  *
394  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_4: 2.16GHz
395  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_5: 2.16GHz and 4.32GHz
396  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_6: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz and 6.48GHz
397  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_7: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz and 8.64GHz
398  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_8: 2.16GHz and 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz
399  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_9: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz and 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz
400  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_10: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz and 2.16GHz+2.16GHz
401  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_11: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 8.64GHz and
402  *	2.16GHz+2.16GHz
403  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_12: 2.16GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and
404  *	4.32GHz + 4.32GHz
405  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_13: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and
406  *	4.32GHz + 4.32GHz
407  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_14: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz
408  *	and 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz
409  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_15: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 8.64GHz,
410  *	2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz
411  */
412 enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config {
413 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_4	= 4,
414 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_5	= 5,
415 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_6	= 6,
416 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_7	= 7,
417 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_8	= 8,
418 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_9	= 9,
419 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_10	= 10,
420 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_11	= 11,
421 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_12	= 12,
422 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_13	= 13,
423 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_14	= 14,
424 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_15	= 15,
425 };
426 
427 /**
428  * struct ieee80211_edmg - EDMG configuration
429  *
430  * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
431  * to describe 802.11ay EDMG configuration
432  *
433  * @channels: bitmap that indicates the 2.16 GHz channel(s)
434  *	that are allowed to be used for transmissions.
435  *	Bit 0 indicates channel 1, bit 1 indicates channel 2, etc.
436  *	Set to 0 indicate EDMG not supported.
437  * @bw_config: Channel BW Configuration subfield encodes
438  *	the allowed channel bandwidth configurations
439  */
440 struct ieee80211_edmg {
441 	u8 channels;
442 	enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config bw_config;
443 };
444 
445 /**
446  * struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap - STA's S1G capabilities
447  *
448  * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
449  * to describe 802.11ah S1G capabilities for a STA.
450  *
451  * @s1g_supported: is STA an S1G STA
452  * @cap: S1G capabilities information
453  * @nss_mcs: Supported NSS MCS set
454  */
455 struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap {
456 	bool s1g;
457 	u8 cap[10]; /* use S1G_CAPAB_ */
458 	u8 nss_mcs[5];
459 };
460 
461 /**
462  * struct ieee80211_supported_band - frequency band definition
463  *
464  * This structure describes a frequency band a wiphy
465  * is able to operate in.
466  *
467  * @channels: Array of channels the hardware can operate with
468  *	in this band.
469  * @band: the band this structure represents
470  * @n_channels: Number of channels in @channels
471  * @bitrates: Array of bitrates the hardware can operate with
472  *	in this band. Must be sorted to give a valid "supported
473  *	rates" IE, i.e. CCK rates first, then OFDM.
474  * @n_bitrates: Number of bitrates in @bitrates
475  * @ht_cap: HT capabilities in this band
476  * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities in this band
477  * @s1g_cap: S1G capabilities in this band
478  * @edmg_cap: EDMG capabilities in this band
479  * @s1g_cap: S1G capabilities in this band (S1B band only, of course)
480  * @n_iftype_data: number of iftype data entries
481  * @iftype_data: interface type data entries.  Note that the bits in
482  *	@types_mask inside this structure cannot overlap (i.e. only
483  *	one occurrence of each type is allowed across all instances of
484  *	iftype_data).
485  */
486 struct ieee80211_supported_band {
487 	struct ieee80211_channel *channels;
488 	struct ieee80211_rate *bitrates;
489 	enum nl80211_band band;
490 	int n_channels;
491 	int n_bitrates;
492 	struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap ht_cap;
493 	struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap vht_cap;
494 	struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap s1g_cap;
495 	struct ieee80211_edmg edmg_cap;
496 	u16 n_iftype_data;
497 	const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *iftype_data;
498 };
499 
500 /**
501  * ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data - return sband data for a given iftype
502  * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on
503  * @iftype: enum nl80211_iftype
504  *
505  * Return: pointer to struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data, or NULL is none found
506  */
507 static inline const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *
ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,u8 iftype)508 ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
509 				u8 iftype)
510 {
511 	int i;
512 
513 	if (WARN_ON(iftype >= NL80211_IFTYPE_MAX))
514 		return NULL;
515 
516 	for (i = 0; i < sband->n_iftype_data; i++)  {
517 		const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data =
518 			&sband->iftype_data[i];
519 
520 		if (data->types_mask & BIT(iftype))
521 			return data;
522 	}
523 
524 	return NULL;
525 }
526 
527 /**
528  * ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap - return HE capabilities for an sband's iftype
529  * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
530  * @iftype: enum nl80211_iftype
531  *
532  * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap, or NULL is none found
533  */
534 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap *
ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,u8 iftype)535 ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
536 			    u8 iftype)
537 {
538 	const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data =
539 		ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftype);
540 
541 	if (data && data->he_cap.has_he)
542 		return &data->he_cap;
543 
544 	return NULL;
545 }
546 
547 /**
548  * ieee80211_get_he_sta_cap - return HE capabilities for an sband's STA
549  * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on
550  *
551  * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap, or NULL is none found
552  */
553 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap *
ieee80211_get_he_sta_cap(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband)554 ieee80211_get_he_sta_cap(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband)
555 {
556 	return ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap(sband, NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION);
557 }
558 
559 /**
560  * ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa - return HE 6 GHz capabilities
561  * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on
562  * @iftype: the iftype to search for
563  *
564  * Return: the 6GHz capabilities
565  */
566 static inline __le16
ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,enum nl80211_iftype iftype)567 ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
568 			   enum nl80211_iftype iftype)
569 {
570 	const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data =
571 		ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftype);
572 
573 	if (WARN_ON(!data || !data->he_cap.has_he))
574 		return 0;
575 
576 	return data->he_6ghz_capa.capa;
577 }
578 
579 /**
580  * wiphy_read_of_freq_limits - read frequency limits from device tree
581  *
582  * @wiphy: the wireless device to get extra limits for
583  *
584  * Some devices may have extra limitations specified in DT. This may be useful
585  * for chipsets that normally support more bands but are limited due to board
586  * design (e.g. by antennas or external power amplifier).
587  *
588  * This function reads info from DT and uses it to *modify* channels (disable
589  * unavailable ones). It's usually a *bad* idea to use it in drivers with
590  * shared channel data as DT limitations are device specific. You should make
591  * sure to call it only if channels in wiphy are copied and can be modified
592  * without affecting other devices.
593  *
594  * As this function access device node it has to be called after set_wiphy_dev.
595  * It also modifies channels so they have to be set first.
596  * If using this helper, call it before wiphy_register().
597  */
598 #ifdef CONFIG_OF
599 void wiphy_read_of_freq_limits(struct wiphy *wiphy);
600 #else /* CONFIG_OF */
wiphy_read_of_freq_limits(struct wiphy * wiphy)601 static inline void wiphy_read_of_freq_limits(struct wiphy *wiphy)
602 {
603 }
604 #endif /* !CONFIG_OF */
605 
606 
607 /*
608  * Wireless hardware/device configuration structures and methods
609  */
610 
611 /**
612  * DOC: Actions and configuration
613  *
614  * Each wireless device and each virtual interface offer a set of configuration
615  * operations and other actions that are invoked by userspace. Each of these
616  * actions is described in the operations structure, and the parameters these
617  * operations use are described separately.
618  *
619  * Additionally, some operations are asynchronous and expect to get status
620  * information via some functions that drivers need to call.
621  *
622  * Scanning and BSS list handling with its associated functionality is described
623  * in a separate chapter.
624  */
625 
626 #define VHT_MUMIMO_GROUPS_DATA_LEN (WLAN_MEMBERSHIP_LEN +\
627 				    WLAN_USER_POSITION_LEN)
628 
629 /**
630  * struct vif_params - describes virtual interface parameters
631  * @flags: monitor interface flags, unchanged if 0, otherwise
632  *	%MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED will be set
633  * @use_4addr: use 4-address frames
634  * @macaddr: address to use for this virtual interface.
635  *	If this parameter is set to zero address the driver may
636  *	determine the address as needed.
637  *	This feature is only fully supported by drivers that enable the
638  *	%NL80211_FEATURE_MAC_ON_CREATE flag.  Others may support creating
639  **	only p2p devices with specified MAC.
640  * @vht_mumimo_groups: MU-MIMO groupID, used for monitoring MU-MIMO packets
641  *	belonging to that MU-MIMO groupID; %NULL if not changed
642  * @vht_mumimo_follow_addr: MU-MIMO follow address, used for monitoring
643  *	MU-MIMO packets going to the specified station; %NULL if not changed
644  */
645 struct vif_params {
646 	u32 flags;
647 	int use_4addr;
648 	u8 macaddr[ETH_ALEN];
649 	const u8 *vht_mumimo_groups;
650 	const u8 *vht_mumimo_follow_addr;
651 };
652 
653 /**
654  * struct key_params - key information
655  *
656  * Information about a key
657  *
658  * @key: key material
659  * @key_len: length of key material
660  * @cipher: cipher suite selector
661  * @seq: sequence counter (IV/PN) for TKIP and CCMP keys, only used
662  *	with the get_key() callback, must be in little endian,
663  *	length given by @seq_len.
664  * @seq_len: length of @seq.
665  * @vlan_id: vlan_id for VLAN group key (if nonzero)
666  * @mode: key install mode (RX_TX, NO_TX or SET_TX)
667  */
668 struct key_params {
669 	const u8 *key;
670 	const u8 *seq;
671 	int key_len;
672 	int seq_len;
673 	u16 vlan_id;
674 	u32 cipher;
675 	enum nl80211_key_mode mode;
676 };
677 
678 /**
679  * struct cfg80211_chan_def - channel definition
680  * @chan: the (control) channel
681  * @width: channel width
682  * @center_freq1: center frequency of first segment
683  * @center_freq2: center frequency of second segment
684  *	(only with 80+80 MHz)
685  * @edmg: define the EDMG channels configuration.
686  *	If edmg is requested (i.e. the .channels member is non-zero),
687  *	chan will define the primary channel and all other
688  *	parameters are ignored.
689  * @freq1_offset: offset from @center_freq1, in KHz
690  */
691 struct cfg80211_chan_def {
692 	struct ieee80211_channel *chan;
693 	enum nl80211_chan_width width;
694 	u32 center_freq1;
695 	u32 center_freq2;
696 	struct ieee80211_edmg edmg;
697 	u16 freq1_offset;
698 };
699 
700 /*
701  * cfg80211_bitrate_mask - masks for bitrate control
702  */
703 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask {
704 	struct {
705 		u32 legacy;
706 		u8 ht_mcs[IEEE80211_HT_MCS_MASK_LEN];
707 		u16 vht_mcs[NL80211_VHT_NSS_MAX];
708 		u16 he_mcs[NL80211_HE_NSS_MAX];
709 		enum nl80211_txrate_gi gi;
710 		enum nl80211_he_gi he_gi;
711 		enum nl80211_he_ltf he_ltf;
712 	} control[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
713 };
714 
715 
716 /**
717  * struct cfg80211_tid_cfg - TID specific configuration
718  * @config_override: Flag to notify driver to reset TID configuration
719  *	of the peer.
720  * @tids: bitmap of TIDs to modify
721  * @mask: bitmap of attributes indicating which parameter changed,
722  *	similar to &nl80211_tid_config_supp.
723  * @noack: noack configuration value for the TID
724  * @retry_long: retry count value
725  * @retry_short: retry count value
726  * @ampdu: Enable/Disable MPDU aggregation
727  * @rtscts: Enable/Disable RTS/CTS
728  * @amsdu: Enable/Disable MSDU aggregation
729  * @txrate_type: Tx bitrate mask type
730  * @txrate_mask: Tx bitrate to be applied for the TID
731  */
732 struct cfg80211_tid_cfg {
733 	bool config_override;
734 	u8 tids;
735 	u64 mask;
736 	enum nl80211_tid_config noack;
737 	u8 retry_long, retry_short;
738 	enum nl80211_tid_config ampdu;
739 	enum nl80211_tid_config rtscts;
740 	enum nl80211_tid_config amsdu;
741 	enum nl80211_tx_rate_setting txrate_type;
742 	struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask txrate_mask;
743 };
744 
745 /**
746  * struct cfg80211_tid_config - TID configuration
747  * @peer: Station's MAC address
748  * @n_tid_conf: Number of TID specific configurations to be applied
749  * @tid_conf: Configuration change info
750  */
751 struct cfg80211_tid_config {
752 	const u8 *peer;
753 	u32 n_tid_conf;
754 	struct cfg80211_tid_cfg tid_conf[];
755 };
756 
757 /**
758  * cfg80211_get_chandef_type - return old channel type from chandef
759  * @chandef: the channel definition
760  *
761  * Return: The old channel type (NOHT, HT20, HT40+/-) from a given
762  * chandef, which must have a bandwidth allowing this conversion.
763  */
764 static inline enum nl80211_channel_type
cfg80211_get_chandef_type(const struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef)765 cfg80211_get_chandef_type(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
766 {
767 	switch (chandef->width) {
768 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT:
769 		return NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT;
770 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20:
771 		return NL80211_CHAN_HT20;
772 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40:
773 		if (chandef->center_freq1 > chandef->chan->center_freq)
774 			return NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS;
775 		return NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS;
776 	default:
777 		WARN_ON(1);
778 		return NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT;
779 	}
780 }
781 
782 /**
783  * cfg80211_chandef_create - create channel definition using channel type
784  * @chandef: the channel definition struct to fill
785  * @channel: the control channel
786  * @chantype: the channel type
787  *
788  * Given a channel type, create a channel definition.
789  */
790 void cfg80211_chandef_create(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
791 			     struct ieee80211_channel *channel,
792 			     enum nl80211_channel_type chantype);
793 
794 /**
795  * cfg80211_chandef_identical - check if two channel definitions are identical
796  * @chandef1: first channel definition
797  * @chandef2: second channel definition
798  *
799  * Return: %true if the channels defined by the channel definitions are
800  * identical, %false otherwise.
801  */
802 static inline bool
cfg80211_chandef_identical(const struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef1,const struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef2)803 cfg80211_chandef_identical(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef1,
804 			   const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef2)
805 {
806 	return (chandef1->chan == chandef2->chan &&
807 		chandef1->width == chandef2->width &&
808 		chandef1->center_freq1 == chandef2->center_freq1 &&
809 		chandef1->freq1_offset == chandef2->freq1_offset &&
810 		chandef1->center_freq2 == chandef2->center_freq2);
811 }
812 
813 /**
814  * cfg80211_chandef_is_edmg - check if chandef represents an EDMG channel
815  *
816  * @chandef: the channel definition
817  *
818  * Return: %true if EDMG defined, %false otherwise.
819  */
820 static inline bool
cfg80211_chandef_is_edmg(const struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef)821 cfg80211_chandef_is_edmg(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
822 {
823 	return chandef->edmg.channels || chandef->edmg.bw_config;
824 }
825 
826 /**
827  * cfg80211_chandef_compatible - check if two channel definitions are compatible
828  * @chandef1: first channel definition
829  * @chandef2: second channel definition
830  *
831  * Return: %NULL if the given channel definitions are incompatible,
832  * chandef1 or chandef2 otherwise.
833  */
834 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *
835 cfg80211_chandef_compatible(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef1,
836 			    const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef2);
837 
838 /**
839  * cfg80211_chandef_valid - check if a channel definition is valid
840  * @chandef: the channel definition to check
841  * Return: %true if the channel definition is valid. %false otherwise.
842  */
843 bool cfg80211_chandef_valid(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
844 
845 /**
846  * cfg80211_chandef_usable - check if secondary channels can be used
847  * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against
848  * @chandef: the channel definition to check
849  * @prohibited_flags: the regulatory channel flags that must not be set
850  * Return: %true if secondary channels are usable. %false otherwise.
851  */
852 bool cfg80211_chandef_usable(struct wiphy *wiphy,
853 			     const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
854 			     u32 prohibited_flags);
855 
856 /**
857  * cfg80211_chandef_dfs_required - checks if radar detection is required
858  * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against
859  * @chandef: the channel definition to check
860  * @iftype: the interface type as specified in &enum nl80211_iftype
861  * Returns:
862  *	1 if radar detection is required, 0 if it is not, < 0 on error
863  */
864 int cfg80211_chandef_dfs_required(struct wiphy *wiphy,
865 				  const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
866 				  enum nl80211_iftype iftype);
867 
868 /**
869  * ieee80211_chandef_rate_flags - returns rate flags for a channel
870  *
871  * In some channel types, not all rates may be used - for example CCK
872  * rates may not be used in 5/10 MHz channels.
873  *
874  * @chandef: channel definition for the channel
875  *
876  * Returns: rate flags which apply for this channel
877  */
878 static inline enum ieee80211_rate_flags
ieee80211_chandef_rate_flags(struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef)879 ieee80211_chandef_rate_flags(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
880 {
881 	switch (chandef->width) {
882 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5:
883 		return IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ;
884 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10:
885 		return IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ;
886 	default:
887 		break;
888 	}
889 	return 0;
890 }
891 
892 /**
893  * ieee80211_chandef_max_power - maximum transmission power for the chandef
894  *
895  * In some regulations, the transmit power may depend on the configured channel
896  * bandwidth which may be defined as dBm/MHz. This function returns the actual
897  * max_power for non-standard (20 MHz) channels.
898  *
899  * @chandef: channel definition for the channel
900  *
901  * Returns: maximum allowed transmission power in dBm for the chandef
902  */
903 static inline int
ieee80211_chandef_max_power(struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef)904 ieee80211_chandef_max_power(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
905 {
906 	switch (chandef->width) {
907 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5:
908 		return min(chandef->chan->max_reg_power - 6,
909 			   chandef->chan->max_power);
910 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10:
911 		return min(chandef->chan->max_reg_power - 3,
912 			   chandef->chan->max_power);
913 	default:
914 		break;
915 	}
916 	return chandef->chan->max_power;
917 }
918 
919 /**
920  * enum survey_info_flags - survey information flags
921  *
922  * @SURVEY_INFO_NOISE_DBM: noise (in dBm) was filled in
923  * @SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE: channel is currently being used
924  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME: active time (in ms) was filled in
925  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY: busy time was filled in
926  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY: extension channel busy time was filled in
927  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX: receive time was filled in
928  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX: transmit time was filled in
929  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN: scan time was filled in
930  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX: local BSS receive time was filled in
931  *
932  * Used by the driver to indicate which info in &struct survey_info
933  * it has filled in during the get_survey().
934  */
935 enum survey_info_flags {
936 	SURVEY_INFO_NOISE_DBM		= BIT(0),
937 	SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE		= BIT(1),
938 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME		= BIT(2),
939 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY		= BIT(3),
940 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY	= BIT(4),
941 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX		= BIT(5),
942 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX		= BIT(6),
943 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN		= BIT(7),
944 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX		= BIT(8),
945 };
946 
947 /**
948  * struct survey_info - channel survey response
949  *
950  * @channel: the channel this survey record reports, may be %NULL for a single
951  *	record to report global statistics
952  * @filled: bitflag of flags from &enum survey_info_flags
953  * @noise: channel noise in dBm. This and all following fields are
954  *	optional
955  * @time: amount of time in ms the radio was turn on (on the channel)
956  * @time_busy: amount of time the primary channel was sensed busy
957  * @time_ext_busy: amount of time the extension channel was sensed busy
958  * @time_rx: amount of time the radio spent receiving data
959  * @time_tx: amount of time the radio spent transmitting data
960  * @time_scan: amount of time the radio spent for scanning
961  * @time_bss_rx: amount of time the radio spent receiving data on a local BSS
962  *
963  * Used by dump_survey() to report back per-channel survey information.
964  *
965  * This structure can later be expanded with things like
966  * channel duty cycle etc.
967  */
968 struct survey_info {
969 	struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
970 	u64 time;
971 	u64 time_busy;
972 	u64 time_ext_busy;
973 	u64 time_rx;
974 	u64 time_tx;
975 	u64 time_scan;
976 	u64 time_bss_rx;
977 	u32 filled;
978 	s8 noise;
979 };
980 
981 #define CFG80211_MAX_WEP_KEYS	4
982 
983 /**
984  * struct cfg80211_crypto_settings - Crypto settings
985  * @wpa_versions: indicates which, if any, WPA versions are enabled
986  *	(from enum nl80211_wpa_versions)
987  * @cipher_group: group key cipher suite (or 0 if unset)
988  * @n_ciphers_pairwise: number of AP supported unicast ciphers
989  * @ciphers_pairwise: unicast key cipher suites
990  * @n_akm_suites: number of AKM suites
991  * @akm_suites: AKM suites
992  * @control_port: Whether user space controls IEEE 802.1X port, i.e.,
993  *	sets/clears %NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED. If true, the driver is
994  *	required to assume that the port is unauthorized until authorized by
995  *	user space. Otherwise, port is marked authorized by default.
996  * @control_port_ethertype: the control port protocol that should be
997  *	allowed through even on unauthorized ports
998  * @control_port_no_encrypt: TRUE to prevent encryption of control port
999  *	protocol frames.
1000  * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control
1001  *	port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface.
1002  * @control_port_no_preauth: disables pre-auth rx over the nl80211 control
1003  *	port for mac80211
1004  * @wep_keys: static WEP keys, if not NULL points to an array of
1005  *	CFG80211_MAX_WEP_KEYS WEP keys
1006  * @wep_tx_key: key index (0..3) of the default TX static WEP key
1007  * @psk: PSK (for devices supporting 4-way-handshake offload)
1008  * @sae_pwd: password for SAE authentication (for devices supporting SAE
1009  *	offload)
1010  * @sae_pwd_len: length of SAE password (for devices supporting SAE offload)
1011  */
1012 struct cfg80211_crypto_settings {
1013 	u32 wpa_versions;
1014 	u32 cipher_group;
1015 	int n_ciphers_pairwise;
1016 	u32 ciphers_pairwise[NL80211_MAX_NR_CIPHER_SUITES];
1017 	int n_akm_suites;
1018 	u32 akm_suites[NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES];
1019 	bool control_port;
1020 	__be16 control_port_ethertype;
1021 	bool control_port_no_encrypt;
1022 	bool control_port_over_nl80211;
1023 	bool control_port_no_preauth;
1024 	struct key_params *wep_keys;
1025 	int wep_tx_key;
1026 	const u8 *psk;
1027 	const u8 *sae_pwd;
1028 	u8 sae_pwd_len;
1029 };
1030 
1031 /**
1032  * struct cfg80211_beacon_data - beacon data
1033  * @head: head portion of beacon (before TIM IE)
1034  *	or %NULL if not changed
1035  * @tail: tail portion of beacon (after TIM IE)
1036  *	or %NULL if not changed
1037  * @head_len: length of @head
1038  * @tail_len: length of @tail
1039  * @beacon_ies: extra information element(s) to add into Beacon frames or %NULL
1040  * @beacon_ies_len: length of beacon_ies in octets
1041  * @proberesp_ies: extra information element(s) to add into Probe Response
1042  *	frames or %NULL
1043  * @proberesp_ies_len: length of proberesp_ies in octets
1044  * @assocresp_ies: extra information element(s) to add into (Re)Association
1045  *	Response frames or %NULL
1046  * @assocresp_ies_len: length of assocresp_ies in octets
1047  * @probe_resp_len: length of probe response template (@probe_resp)
1048  * @probe_resp: probe response template (AP mode only)
1049  * @ftm_responder: enable FTM responder functionality; -1 for no change
1050  *	(which also implies no change in LCI/civic location data)
1051  * @lci: Measurement Report element content, starting with Measurement Token
1052  *	(measurement type 8)
1053  * @civicloc: Measurement Report element content, starting with Measurement
1054  *	Token (measurement type 11)
1055  * @lci_len: LCI data length
1056  * @civicloc_len: Civic location data length
1057  */
1058 struct cfg80211_beacon_data {
1059 	const u8 *head, *tail;
1060 	const u8 *beacon_ies;
1061 	const u8 *proberesp_ies;
1062 	const u8 *assocresp_ies;
1063 	const u8 *probe_resp;
1064 	const u8 *lci;
1065 	const u8 *civicloc;
1066 	s8 ftm_responder;
1067 
1068 	size_t head_len, tail_len;
1069 	size_t beacon_ies_len;
1070 	size_t proberesp_ies_len;
1071 	size_t assocresp_ies_len;
1072 	size_t probe_resp_len;
1073 	size_t lci_len;
1074 	size_t civicloc_len;
1075 };
1076 
1077 struct mac_address {
1078 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
1079 };
1080 
1081 /**
1082  * struct cfg80211_acl_data - Access control list data
1083  *
1084  * @acl_policy: ACL policy to be applied on the station's
1085  *	entry specified by mac_addr
1086  * @n_acl_entries: Number of MAC address entries passed
1087  * @mac_addrs: List of MAC addresses of stations to be used for ACL
1088  */
1089 struct cfg80211_acl_data {
1090 	enum nl80211_acl_policy acl_policy;
1091 	int n_acl_entries;
1092 
1093 	/* Keep it last */
1094 	struct mac_address mac_addrs[];
1095 };
1096 
1097 /**
1098  * struct cfg80211_fils_discovery - FILS discovery parameters from
1099  * IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail.
1100  *
1101  * @min_interval: Minimum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
1102  * @max_interval: Maximum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
1103  * @tmpl_len: Template length
1104  * @tmpl: Template data for FILS discovery frame including the action
1105  *	frame headers.
1106  */
1107 struct cfg80211_fils_discovery {
1108 	u32 min_interval;
1109 	u32 max_interval;
1110 	size_t tmpl_len;
1111 	const u8 *tmpl;
1112 };
1113 
1114 /**
1115  * struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp - Unsolicited broadcast probe
1116  *	response parameters in 6GHz.
1117  *
1118  * @interval: Packet interval in TUs. Maximum allowed is 20 TU, as mentioned
1119  *	in IEEE P802.11ax/D6.0 26.17.2.3.2 - AP behavior for fast passive
1120  *	scanning
1121  * @tmpl_len: Template length
1122  * @tmpl: Template data for probe response
1123  */
1124 struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp {
1125 	u32 interval;
1126 	size_t tmpl_len;
1127 	const u8 *tmpl;
1128 };
1129 
1130 /**
1131  * enum cfg80211_ap_settings_flags - AP settings flags
1132  *
1133  * Used by cfg80211_ap_settings
1134  *
1135  * @AP_SETTINGS_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT: AP supports external authentication
1136  */
1137 enum cfg80211_ap_settings_flags {
1138 	AP_SETTINGS_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT = BIT(0),
1139 };
1140 
1141 /**
1142  * struct cfg80211_ap_settings - AP configuration
1143  *
1144  * Used to configure an AP interface.
1145  *
1146  * @chandef: defines the channel to use
1147  * @beacon: beacon data
1148  * @beacon_interval: beacon interval
1149  * @dtim_period: DTIM period
1150  * @ssid: SSID to be used in the BSS (note: may be %NULL if not provided from
1151  *	user space)
1152  * @ssid_len: length of @ssid
1153  * @hidden_ssid: whether to hide the SSID in Beacon/Probe Response frames
1154  * @crypto: crypto settings
1155  * @privacy: the BSS uses privacy
1156  * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm)
1157  * @smps_mode: SMPS mode
1158  * @inactivity_timeout: time in seconds to determine station's inactivity.
1159  * @p2p_ctwindow: P2P CT Window
1160  * @p2p_opp_ps: P2P opportunistic PS
1161  * @acl: ACL configuration used by the drivers which has support for
1162  *	MAC address based access control
1163  * @pbss: If set, start as a PCP instead of AP. Relevant for DMG
1164  *	networks.
1165  * @beacon_rate: bitrate to be used for beacons
1166  * @ht_cap: HT capabilities (or %NULL if HT isn't enabled)
1167  * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities (or %NULL if VHT isn't enabled)
1168  * @he_cap: HE capabilities (or %NULL if HE isn't enabled)
1169  * @ht_required: stations must support HT
1170  * @vht_required: stations must support VHT
1171  * @twt_responder: Enable Target Wait Time
1172  * @he_required: stations must support HE
1173  * @flags: flags, as defined in enum cfg80211_ap_settings_flags
1174  * @he_obss_pd: OBSS Packet Detection settings
1175  * @he_bss_color: BSS Color settings
1176  * @he_oper: HE operation IE (or %NULL if HE isn't enabled)
1177  * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery transmission parameters
1178  * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp: Unsolicited broadcast probe response parameters
1179  */
1180 struct cfg80211_ap_settings {
1181 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1182 
1183 	struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon;
1184 
1185 	int beacon_interval, dtim_period;
1186 	const u8 *ssid;
1187 	size_t ssid_len;
1188 	enum nl80211_hidden_ssid hidden_ssid;
1189 	struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto;
1190 	bool privacy;
1191 	enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type;
1192 	enum nl80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
1193 	int inactivity_timeout;
1194 	u8 p2p_ctwindow;
1195 	bool p2p_opp_ps;
1196 	const struct cfg80211_acl_data *acl;
1197 	bool pbss;
1198 	struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_rate;
1199 
1200 	const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_cap;
1201 	const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_cap;
1202 	const struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem *he_cap;
1203 	const struct ieee80211_he_operation *he_oper;
1204 	bool ht_required, vht_required, he_required;
1205 	bool twt_responder;
1206 	u32 flags;
1207 	struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd he_obss_pd;
1208 	struct cfg80211_he_bss_color he_bss_color;
1209 	struct cfg80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery;
1210 	struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp unsol_bcast_probe_resp;
1211 };
1212 
1213 /**
1214  * struct cfg80211_csa_settings - channel switch settings
1215  *
1216  * Used for channel switch
1217  *
1218  * @chandef: defines the channel to use after the switch
1219  * @beacon_csa: beacon data while performing the switch
1220  * @counter_offsets_beacon: offsets of the counters within the beacon (tail)
1221  * @counter_offsets_presp: offsets of the counters within the probe response
1222  * @n_counter_offsets_beacon: number of csa counters the beacon (tail)
1223  * @n_counter_offsets_presp: number of csa counters in the probe response
1224  * @beacon_after: beacon data to be used on the new channel
1225  * @radar_required: whether radar detection is required on the new channel
1226  * @block_tx: whether transmissions should be blocked while changing
1227  * @count: number of beacons until switch
1228  */
1229 struct cfg80211_csa_settings {
1230 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1231 	struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_csa;
1232 	const u16 *counter_offsets_beacon;
1233 	const u16 *counter_offsets_presp;
1234 	unsigned int n_counter_offsets_beacon;
1235 	unsigned int n_counter_offsets_presp;
1236 	struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_after;
1237 	bool radar_required;
1238 	bool block_tx;
1239 	u8 count;
1240 };
1241 
1242 #define CFG80211_MAX_NUM_DIFFERENT_CHANNELS 10
1243 
1244 /**
1245  * struct iface_combination_params - input parameters for interface combinations
1246  *
1247  * Used to pass interface combination parameters
1248  *
1249  * @num_different_channels: the number of different channels we want
1250  *	to use for verification
1251  * @radar_detect: a bitmap where each bit corresponds to a channel
1252  *	width where radar detection is needed, as in the definition of
1253  *	&struct ieee80211_iface_combination.@radar_detect_widths
1254  * @iftype_num: array with the number of interfaces of each interface
1255  *	type.  The index is the interface type as specified in &enum
1256  *	nl80211_iftype.
1257  * @new_beacon_int: set this to the beacon interval of a new interface
1258  *	that's not operating yet, if such is to be checked as part of
1259  *	the verification
1260  */
1261 struct iface_combination_params {
1262 	int num_different_channels;
1263 	u8 radar_detect;
1264 	int iftype_num[NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES];
1265 	u32 new_beacon_int;
1266 };
1267 
1268 /**
1269  * enum station_parameters_apply_mask - station parameter values to apply
1270  * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_UAPSD: apply new uAPSD parameters (uapsd_queues, max_sp)
1271  * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_CAPABILITY: apply new capability
1272  * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_PLINK_STATE: apply new plink state
1273  *
1274  * Not all station parameters have in-band "no change" signalling,
1275  * for those that don't these flags will are used.
1276  */
1277 enum station_parameters_apply_mask {
1278 	STATION_PARAM_APPLY_UAPSD = BIT(0),
1279 	STATION_PARAM_APPLY_CAPABILITY = BIT(1),
1280 	STATION_PARAM_APPLY_PLINK_STATE = BIT(2),
1281 	STATION_PARAM_APPLY_STA_TXPOWER = BIT(3),
1282 };
1283 
1284 /**
1285  * struct sta_txpwr - station txpower configuration
1286  *
1287  * Used to configure txpower for station.
1288  *
1289  * @power: tx power (in dBm) to be used for sending data traffic. If tx power
1290  *	is not provided, the default per-interface tx power setting will be
1291  *	overriding. Driver should be picking up the lowest tx power, either tx
1292  *	power per-interface or per-station.
1293  * @type: In particular if TPC %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED then tx power
1294  *	will be less than or equal to specified from userspace, whereas if TPC
1295  *	%type is NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC then it indicates default tx power.
1296  *	NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED is not a valid configuration option for
1297  *	per peer TPC.
1298  */
1299 struct sta_txpwr {
1300 	s16 power;
1301 	enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type;
1302 };
1303 
1304 /**
1305  * struct station_parameters - station parameters
1306  *
1307  * Used to change and create a new station.
1308  *
1309  * @vlan: vlan interface station should belong to
1310  * @supported_rates: supported rates in IEEE 802.11 format
1311  *	(or NULL for no change)
1312  * @supported_rates_len: number of supported rates
1313  * @sta_flags_mask: station flags that changed
1314  *	(bitmask of BIT(%NL80211_STA_FLAG_...))
1315  * @sta_flags_set: station flags values
1316  *	(bitmask of BIT(%NL80211_STA_FLAG_...))
1317  * @listen_interval: listen interval or -1 for no change
1318  * @aid: AID or zero for no change
1319  * @vlan_id: VLAN ID for station (if nonzero)
1320  * @peer_aid: mesh peer AID or zero for no change
1321  * @plink_action: plink action to take
1322  * @plink_state: set the peer link state for a station
1323  * @ht_capa: HT capabilities of station
1324  * @vht_capa: VHT capabilities of station
1325  * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. same format
1326  *	as the AC bitmap in the QoS info field
1327  * @max_sp: max Service Period. same format as the MAX_SP in the
1328  *	QoS info field (but already shifted down)
1329  * @sta_modify_mask: bitmap indicating which parameters changed
1330  *	(for those that don't have a natural "no change" value),
1331  *	see &enum station_parameters_apply_mask
1332  * @local_pm: local link-specific mesh power save mode (no change when set
1333  *	to unknown)
1334  * @capability: station capability
1335  * @ext_capab: extended capabilities of the station
1336  * @ext_capab_len: number of extended capabilities
1337  * @supported_channels: supported channels in IEEE 802.11 format
1338  * @supported_channels_len: number of supported channels
1339  * @supported_oper_classes: supported oper classes in IEEE 802.11 format
1340  * @supported_oper_classes_len: number of supported operating classes
1341  * @opmode_notif: operating mode field from Operating Mode Notification
1342  * @opmode_notif_used: information if operating mode field is used
1343  * @support_p2p_ps: information if station supports P2P PS mechanism
1344  * @he_capa: HE capabilities of station
1345  * @he_capa_len: the length of the HE capabilities
1346  * @airtime_weight: airtime scheduler weight for this station
1347  * @txpwr: transmit power for an associated station
1348  * @he_6ghz_capa: HE 6 GHz Band capabilities of station
1349  */
1350 struct station_parameters {
1351 	const u8 *supported_rates;
1352 	struct net_device *vlan;
1353 	u32 sta_flags_mask, sta_flags_set;
1354 	u32 sta_modify_mask;
1355 	int listen_interval;
1356 	u16 aid;
1357 	u16 vlan_id;
1358 	u16 peer_aid;
1359 	u8 supported_rates_len;
1360 	u8 plink_action;
1361 	u8 plink_state;
1362 	const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_capa;
1363 	const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_capa;
1364 	u8 uapsd_queues;
1365 	u8 max_sp;
1366 	enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode local_pm;
1367 	u16 capability;
1368 	const u8 *ext_capab;
1369 	u8 ext_capab_len;
1370 	const u8 *supported_channels;
1371 	u8 supported_channels_len;
1372 	const u8 *supported_oper_classes;
1373 	u8 supported_oper_classes_len;
1374 	u8 opmode_notif;
1375 	bool opmode_notif_used;
1376 	int support_p2p_ps;
1377 	const struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem *he_capa;
1378 	u8 he_capa_len;
1379 	u16 airtime_weight;
1380 	struct sta_txpwr txpwr;
1381 	const struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa *he_6ghz_capa;
1382 };
1383 
1384 /**
1385  * struct station_del_parameters - station deletion parameters
1386  *
1387  * Used to delete a station entry (or all stations).
1388  *
1389  * @mac: MAC address of the station to remove or NULL to remove all stations
1390  * @subtype: Management frame subtype to use for indicating removal
1391  *	(10 = Disassociation, 12 = Deauthentication)
1392  * @reason_code: Reason code for the Disassociation/Deauthentication frame
1393  */
1394 struct station_del_parameters {
1395 	const u8 *mac;
1396 	u8 subtype;
1397 	u16 reason_code;
1398 };
1399 
1400 /**
1401  * enum cfg80211_station_type - the type of station being modified
1402  * @CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT: client of an AP interface
1403  * @CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT_UNASSOC: client of an AP interface that is still
1404  *	unassociated (update properties for this type of client is permitted)
1405  * @CFG80211_STA_AP_MLME_CLIENT: client of an AP interface that has
1406  *	the AP MLME in the device
1407  * @CFG80211_STA_AP_STA: AP station on managed interface
1408  * @CFG80211_STA_IBSS: IBSS station
1409  * @CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_SETUP: TDLS peer on managed interface (dummy entry
1410  *	while TDLS setup is in progress, it moves out of this state when
1411  *	being marked authorized; use this only if TDLS with external setup is
1412  *	supported/used)
1413  * @CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_ACTIVE: TDLS peer on managed interface (active
1414  *	entry that is operating, has been marked authorized by userspace)
1415  * @CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_KERNEL: peer on mesh interface (kernel managed)
1416  * @CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_USER: peer on mesh interface (user managed)
1417  */
1418 enum cfg80211_station_type {
1419 	CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT,
1420 	CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT_UNASSOC,
1421 	CFG80211_STA_AP_MLME_CLIENT,
1422 	CFG80211_STA_AP_STA,
1423 	CFG80211_STA_IBSS,
1424 	CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_SETUP,
1425 	CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_ACTIVE,
1426 	CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_KERNEL,
1427 	CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_USER,
1428 };
1429 
1430 /**
1431  * cfg80211_check_station_change - validate parameter changes
1432  * @wiphy: the wiphy this operates on
1433  * @params: the new parameters for a station
1434  * @statype: the type of station being modified
1435  *
1436  * Utility function for the @change_station driver method. Call this function
1437  * with the appropriate station type looking up the station (and checking that
1438  * it exists). It will verify whether the station change is acceptable, and if
1439  * not will return an error code. Note that it may modify the parameters for
1440  * backward compatibility reasons, so don't use them before calling this.
1441  */
1442 int cfg80211_check_station_change(struct wiphy *wiphy,
1443 				  struct station_parameters *params,
1444 				  enum cfg80211_station_type statype);
1445 
1446 /**
1447  * enum rate_info_flags - bitrate info flags
1448  *
1449  * Used by the driver to indicate the specific rate transmission
1450  * type for 802.11n transmissions.
1451  *
1452  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_MCS: mcs field filled with HT MCS
1453  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_VHT_MCS: mcs field filled with VHT MCS
1454  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_SHORT_GI: 400ns guard interval
1455  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_DMG: 60GHz MCS
1456  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_HE_MCS: HE MCS information
1457  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EDMG: 60GHz MCS in EDMG mode
1458  */
1459 enum rate_info_flags {
1460 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_MCS			= BIT(0),
1461 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_VHT_MCS			= BIT(1),
1462 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_SHORT_GI		= BIT(2),
1463 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_DMG			= BIT(3),
1464 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_HE_MCS			= BIT(4),
1465 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EDMG			= BIT(5),
1466 };
1467 
1468 /**
1469  * enum rate_info_bw - rate bandwidth information
1470  *
1471  * Used by the driver to indicate the rate bandwidth.
1472  *
1473  * @RATE_INFO_BW_5: 5 MHz bandwidth
1474  * @RATE_INFO_BW_10: 10 MHz bandwidth
1475  * @RATE_INFO_BW_20: 20 MHz bandwidth
1476  * @RATE_INFO_BW_40: 40 MHz bandwidth
1477  * @RATE_INFO_BW_80: 80 MHz bandwidth
1478  * @RATE_INFO_BW_160: 160 MHz bandwidth
1479  * @RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU: bandwidth determined by HE RU allocation
1480  */
1481 enum rate_info_bw {
1482 	RATE_INFO_BW_20 = 0,
1483 	RATE_INFO_BW_5,
1484 	RATE_INFO_BW_10,
1485 	RATE_INFO_BW_40,
1486 	RATE_INFO_BW_80,
1487 	RATE_INFO_BW_160,
1488 	RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU,
1489 };
1490 
1491 /**
1492  * struct rate_info - bitrate information
1493  *
1494  * Information about a receiving or transmitting bitrate
1495  *
1496  * @flags: bitflag of flags from &enum rate_info_flags
1497  * @mcs: mcs index if struct describes an HT/VHT/HE rate
1498  * @legacy: bitrate in 100kbit/s for 802.11abg
1499  * @nss: number of streams (VHT & HE only)
1500  * @bw: bandwidth (from &enum rate_info_bw)
1501  * @he_gi: HE guard interval (from &enum nl80211_he_gi)
1502  * @he_dcm: HE DCM value
1503  * @he_ru_alloc: HE RU allocation (from &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc,
1504  *	only valid if bw is %RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU)
1505  * @n_bonded_ch: In case of EDMG the number of bonded channels (1-4)
1506  */
1507 struct rate_info {
1508 	u8 flags;
1509 	u8 mcs;
1510 	u16 legacy;
1511 	u8 nss;
1512 	u8 bw;
1513 	u8 he_gi;
1514 	u8 he_dcm;
1515 	u8 he_ru_alloc;
1516 	u8 n_bonded_ch;
1517 };
1518 
1519 /**
1520  * enum bss_param_flags - bitrate info flags
1521  *
1522  * Used by the driver to indicate the specific rate transmission
1523  * type for 802.11n transmissions.
1524  *
1525  * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_CTS_PROT: whether CTS protection is enabled
1526  * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_PREAMBLE: whether short preamble is enabled
1527  * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME: whether short slot time is enabled
1528  */
1529 enum bss_param_flags {
1530 	BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_CTS_PROT	= 1<<0,
1531 	BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_PREAMBLE	= 1<<1,
1532 	BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME	= 1<<2,
1533 };
1534 
1535 /**
1536  * struct sta_bss_parameters - BSS parameters for the attached station
1537  *
1538  * Information about the currently associated BSS
1539  *
1540  * @flags: bitflag of flags from &enum bss_param_flags
1541  * @dtim_period: DTIM period for the BSS
1542  * @beacon_interval: beacon interval
1543  */
1544 struct sta_bss_parameters {
1545 	u8 flags;
1546 	u8 dtim_period;
1547 	u16 beacon_interval;
1548 };
1549 
1550 /**
1551  * struct cfg80211_txq_stats - TXQ statistics for this TID
1552  * @filled: bitmap of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_txq_stats to
1553  *	indicate the relevant values in this struct are filled
1554  * @backlog_bytes: total number of bytes currently backlogged
1555  * @backlog_packets: total number of packets currently backlogged
1556  * @flows: number of new flows seen
1557  * @drops: total number of packets dropped
1558  * @ecn_marks: total number of packets marked with ECN CE
1559  * @overlimit: number of drops due to queue space overflow
1560  * @overmemory: number of drops due to memory limit overflow
1561  * @collisions: number of hash collisions
1562  * @tx_bytes: total number of bytes dequeued
1563  * @tx_packets: total number of packets dequeued
1564  * @max_flows: maximum number of flows supported
1565  */
1566 struct cfg80211_txq_stats {
1567 	u32 filled;
1568 	u32 backlog_bytes;
1569 	u32 backlog_packets;
1570 	u32 flows;
1571 	u32 drops;
1572 	u32 ecn_marks;
1573 	u32 overlimit;
1574 	u32 overmemory;
1575 	u32 collisions;
1576 	u32 tx_bytes;
1577 	u32 tx_packets;
1578 	u32 max_flows;
1579 };
1580 
1581 /**
1582  * struct cfg80211_tid_stats - per-TID statistics
1583  * @filled: bitmap of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_tid_stats to
1584  *	indicate the relevant values in this struct are filled
1585  * @rx_msdu: number of received MSDUs
1586  * @tx_msdu: number of (attempted) transmitted MSDUs
1587  * @tx_msdu_retries: number of retries (not counting the first) for
1588  *	transmitted MSDUs
1589  * @tx_msdu_failed: number of failed transmitted MSDUs
1590  * @txq_stats: TXQ statistics
1591  */
1592 struct cfg80211_tid_stats {
1593 	u32 filled;
1594 	u64 rx_msdu;
1595 	u64 tx_msdu;
1596 	u64 tx_msdu_retries;
1597 	u64 tx_msdu_failed;
1598 	struct cfg80211_txq_stats txq_stats;
1599 };
1600 
1601 #define IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS	4
1602 
1603 /**
1604  * struct station_info - station information
1605  *
1606  * Station information filled by driver for get_station() and dump_station.
1607  *
1608  * @filled: bitflag of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_sta_info to
1609  *	indicate the relevant values in this struct for them
1610  * @connected_time: time(in secs) since a station is last connected
1611  * @inactive_time: time since last station activity (tx/rx) in milliseconds
1612  * @assoc_at: bootime (ns) of the last association
1613  * @rx_bytes: bytes (size of MPDUs) received from this station
1614  * @tx_bytes: bytes (size of MPDUs) transmitted to this station
1615  * @llid: mesh local link id
1616  * @plid: mesh peer link id
1617  * @plink_state: mesh peer link state
1618  * @signal: The signal strength, type depends on the wiphy's signal_type.
1619  *	For CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM, value is expressed in _dBm_.
1620  * @signal_avg: Average signal strength, type depends on the wiphy's signal_type.
1621  *	For CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM, value is expressed in _dBm_.
1622  * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal, @chain_signal_avg
1623  * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received packet in dBm
1624  * @chain_signal_avg: per-chain signal strength average in dBm
1625  * @txrate: current unicast bitrate from this station
1626  * @rxrate: current unicast bitrate to this station
1627  * @rx_packets: packets (MSDUs & MMPDUs) received from this station
1628  * @tx_packets: packets (MSDUs & MMPDUs) transmitted to this station
1629  * @tx_retries: cumulative retry counts (MPDUs)
1630  * @tx_failed: number of failed transmissions (MPDUs) (retries exceeded, no ACK)
1631  * @rx_dropped_misc:  Dropped for un-specified reason.
1632  * @bss_param: current BSS parameters
1633  * @generation: generation number for nl80211 dumps.
1634  *	This number should increase every time the list of stations
1635  *	changes, i.e. when a station is added or removed, so that
1636  *	userspace can tell whether it got a consistent snapshot.
1637  * @assoc_req_ies: IEs from (Re)Association Request.
1638  *	This is used only when in AP mode with drivers that do not use
1639  *	user space MLME/SME implementation. The information is provided for
1640  *	the cfg80211_new_sta() calls to notify user space of the IEs.
1641  * @assoc_req_ies_len: Length of assoc_req_ies buffer in octets.
1642  * @sta_flags: station flags mask & values
1643  * @beacon_loss_count: Number of times beacon loss event has triggered.
1644  * @t_offset: Time offset of the station relative to this host.
1645  * @local_pm: local mesh STA power save mode
1646  * @peer_pm: peer mesh STA power save mode
1647  * @nonpeer_pm: non-peer mesh STA power save mode
1648  * @expected_throughput: expected throughput in kbps (including 802.11 headers)
1649  *	towards this station.
1650  * @rx_beacon: number of beacons received from this peer
1651  * @rx_beacon_signal_avg: signal strength average (in dBm) for beacons received
1652  *	from this peer
1653  * @connected_to_gate: true if mesh STA has a path to mesh gate
1654  * @rx_duration: aggregate PPDU duration(usecs) for all the frames from a peer
1655  * @tx_duration: aggregate PPDU duration(usecs) for all the frames to a peer
1656  * @airtime_weight: current airtime scheduling weight
1657  * @pertid: per-TID statistics, see &struct cfg80211_tid_stats, using the last
1658  *	(IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS) index for MSDUs not encapsulated in QoS-MPDUs.
1659  *	Note that this doesn't use the @filled bit, but is used if non-NULL.
1660  * @ack_signal: signal strength (in dBm) of the last ACK frame.
1661  * @avg_ack_signal: average rssi value of ack packet for the no of msdu's has
1662  *	been sent.
1663  * @rx_mpdu_count: number of MPDUs received from this station
1664  * @fcs_err_count: number of packets (MPDUs) received from this station with
1665  *	an FCS error. This counter should be incremented only when TA of the
1666  *	received packet with an FCS error matches the peer MAC address.
1667  * @airtime_link_metric: mesh airtime link metric.
1668  * @connected_to_as: true if mesh STA has a path to authentication server
1669  */
1670 struct station_info {
1671 	u64 filled;
1672 	u32 connected_time;
1673 	u32 inactive_time;
1674 	u64 assoc_at;
1675 	u64 rx_bytes;
1676 	u64 tx_bytes;
1677 	u16 llid;
1678 	u16 plid;
1679 	u8 plink_state;
1680 	s8 signal;
1681 	s8 signal_avg;
1682 
1683 	u8 chains;
1684 	s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
1685 	s8 chain_signal_avg[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
1686 
1687 	struct rate_info txrate;
1688 	struct rate_info rxrate;
1689 	u32 rx_packets;
1690 	u32 tx_packets;
1691 	u32 tx_retries;
1692 	u32 tx_failed;
1693 	u32 rx_dropped_misc;
1694 	struct sta_bss_parameters bss_param;
1695 	struct nl80211_sta_flag_update sta_flags;
1696 
1697 	int generation;
1698 
1699 	const u8 *assoc_req_ies;
1700 	size_t assoc_req_ies_len;
1701 
1702 	u32 beacon_loss_count;
1703 	s64 t_offset;
1704 	enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode local_pm;
1705 	enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode peer_pm;
1706 	enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode nonpeer_pm;
1707 
1708 	u32 expected_throughput;
1709 
1710 	u64 tx_duration;
1711 	u64 rx_duration;
1712 	u64 rx_beacon;
1713 	u8 rx_beacon_signal_avg;
1714 	u8 connected_to_gate;
1715 
1716 	struct cfg80211_tid_stats *pertid;
1717 	s8 ack_signal;
1718 	s8 avg_ack_signal;
1719 
1720 	u16 airtime_weight;
1721 
1722 	u32 rx_mpdu_count;
1723 	u32 fcs_err_count;
1724 
1725 	u32 airtime_link_metric;
1726 
1727 	u8 connected_to_as;
1728 };
1729 
1730 #if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_CFG80211)
1731 /**
1732  * cfg80211_get_station - retrieve information about a given station
1733  * @dev: the device where the station is supposed to be connected to
1734  * @mac_addr: the mac address of the station of interest
1735  * @sinfo: pointer to the structure to fill with the information
1736  *
1737  * Returns 0 on success and sinfo is filled with the available information
1738  * otherwise returns a negative error code and the content of sinfo has to be
1739  * considered undefined.
1740  */
1741 int cfg80211_get_station(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr,
1742 			 struct station_info *sinfo);
1743 #else
cfg80211_get_station(struct net_device * dev,const u8 * mac_addr,struct station_info * sinfo)1744 static inline int cfg80211_get_station(struct net_device *dev,
1745 				       const u8 *mac_addr,
1746 				       struct station_info *sinfo)
1747 {
1748 	return -ENOENT;
1749 }
1750 #endif
1751 
1752 /**
1753  * enum monitor_flags - monitor flags
1754  *
1755  * Monitor interface configuration flags. Note that these must be the bits
1756  * according to the nl80211 flags.
1757  *
1758  * @MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED: set if the flags were changed
1759  * @MONITOR_FLAG_FCSFAIL: pass frames with bad FCS
1760  * @MONITOR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with bad PLCP
1761  * @MONITOR_FLAG_CONTROL: pass control frames
1762  * @MONITOR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS: disable BSSID filtering
1763  * @MONITOR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES: report frames after processing
1764  * @MONITOR_FLAG_ACTIVE: active monitor, ACKs frames on its MAC address
1765  */
1766 enum monitor_flags {
1767 	MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED		= 1<<__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_INVALID,
1768 	MONITOR_FLAG_FCSFAIL		= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_FCSFAIL,
1769 	MONITOR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL		= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL,
1770 	MONITOR_FLAG_CONTROL		= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_CONTROL,
1771 	MONITOR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS		= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS,
1772 	MONITOR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES	= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES,
1773 	MONITOR_FLAG_ACTIVE		= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_ACTIVE,
1774 };
1775 
1776 /**
1777  * enum mpath_info_flags -  mesh path information flags
1778  *
1779  * Used by the driver to indicate which info in &struct mpath_info it has filled
1780  * in during get_station() or dump_station().
1781  *
1782  * @MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN: @frame_qlen filled
1783  * @MPATH_INFO_SN: @sn filled
1784  * @MPATH_INFO_METRIC: @metric filled
1785  * @MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME: @exptime filled
1786  * @MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT: @discovery_timeout filled
1787  * @MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES: @discovery_retries filled
1788  * @MPATH_INFO_FLAGS: @flags filled
1789  * @MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT: @hop_count filled
1790  * @MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE: @path_change_count filled
1791  */
1792 enum mpath_info_flags {
1793 	MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN		= BIT(0),
1794 	MPATH_INFO_SN			= BIT(1),
1795 	MPATH_INFO_METRIC		= BIT(2),
1796 	MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME		= BIT(3),
1797 	MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT	= BIT(4),
1798 	MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES	= BIT(5),
1799 	MPATH_INFO_FLAGS		= BIT(6),
1800 	MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT		= BIT(7),
1801 	MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE		= BIT(8),
1802 };
1803 
1804 /**
1805  * struct mpath_info - mesh path information
1806  *
1807  * Mesh path information filled by driver for get_mpath() and dump_mpath().
1808  *
1809  * @filled: bitfield of flags from &enum mpath_info_flags
1810  * @frame_qlen: number of queued frames for this destination
1811  * @sn: target sequence number
1812  * @metric: metric (cost) of this mesh path
1813  * @exptime: expiration time for the mesh path from now, in msecs
1814  * @flags: mesh path flags
1815  * @discovery_timeout: total mesh path discovery timeout, in msecs
1816  * @discovery_retries: mesh path discovery retries
1817  * @generation: generation number for nl80211 dumps.
1818  *	This number should increase every time the list of mesh paths
1819  *	changes, i.e. when a station is added or removed, so that
1820  *	userspace can tell whether it got a consistent snapshot.
1821  * @hop_count: hops to destination
1822  * @path_change_count: total number of path changes to destination
1823  */
1824 struct mpath_info {
1825 	u32 filled;
1826 	u32 frame_qlen;
1827 	u32 sn;
1828 	u32 metric;
1829 	u32 exptime;
1830 	u32 discovery_timeout;
1831 	u8 discovery_retries;
1832 	u8 flags;
1833 	u8 hop_count;
1834 	u32 path_change_count;
1835 
1836 	int generation;
1837 };
1838 
1839 /**
1840  * struct bss_parameters - BSS parameters
1841  *
1842  * Used to change BSS parameters (mainly for AP mode).
1843  *
1844  * @use_cts_prot: Whether to use CTS protection
1845  *	(0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change)
1846  * @use_short_preamble: Whether the use of short preambles is allowed
1847  *	(0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change)
1848  * @use_short_slot_time: Whether the use of short slot time is allowed
1849  *	(0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change)
1850  * @basic_rates: basic rates in IEEE 802.11 format
1851  *	(or NULL for no change)
1852  * @basic_rates_len: number of basic rates
1853  * @ap_isolate: do not forward packets between connected stations
1854  *	(0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change)
1855  * @ht_opmode: HT Operation mode
1856  *	(u16 = opmode, -1 = do not change)
1857  * @p2p_ctwindow: P2P CT Window (-1 = no change)
1858  * @p2p_opp_ps: P2P opportunistic PS (-1 = no change)
1859  */
1860 struct bss_parameters {
1861 	int use_cts_prot;
1862 	int use_short_preamble;
1863 	int use_short_slot_time;
1864 	const u8 *basic_rates;
1865 	u8 basic_rates_len;
1866 	int ap_isolate;
1867 	int ht_opmode;
1868 	s8 p2p_ctwindow, p2p_opp_ps;
1869 };
1870 
1871 /**
1872  * struct mesh_config - 802.11s mesh configuration
1873  *
1874  * These parameters can be changed while the mesh is active.
1875  *
1876  * @dot11MeshRetryTimeout: the initial retry timeout in millisecond units used
1877  *	by the Mesh Peering Open message
1878  * @dot11MeshConfirmTimeout: the initial retry timeout in millisecond units
1879  *	used by the Mesh Peering Open message
1880  * @dot11MeshHoldingTimeout: the confirm timeout in millisecond units used by
1881  *	the mesh peering management to close a mesh peering
1882  * @dot11MeshMaxPeerLinks: the maximum number of peer links allowed on this
1883  *	mesh interface
1884  * @dot11MeshMaxRetries: the maximum number of peer link open retries that can
1885  *	be sent to establish a new peer link instance in a mesh
1886  * @dot11MeshTTL: the value of TTL field set at a source mesh STA
1887  * @element_ttl: the value of TTL field set at a mesh STA for path selection
1888  *	elements
1889  * @auto_open_plinks: whether we should automatically open peer links when we
1890  *	detect compatible mesh peers
1891  * @dot11MeshNbrOffsetMaxNeighbor: the maximum number of neighbors to
1892  *	synchronize to for 11s default synchronization method
1893  * @dot11MeshHWMPmaxPREQretries: the number of action frames containing a PREQ
1894  *	that an originator mesh STA can send to a particular path target
1895  * @path_refresh_time: how frequently to refresh mesh paths in milliseconds
1896  * @min_discovery_timeout: the minimum length of time to wait until giving up on
1897  *	a path discovery in milliseconds
1898  * @dot11MeshHWMPactivePathTimeout: the time (in TUs) for which mesh STAs
1899  *	receiving a PREQ shall consider the forwarding information from the
1900  *	root to be valid. (TU = time unit)
1901  * @dot11MeshHWMPpreqMinInterval: the minimum interval of time (in TUs) during
1902  *	which a mesh STA can send only one action frame containing a PREQ
1903  *	element
1904  * @dot11MeshHWMPperrMinInterval: the minimum interval of time (in TUs) during
1905  *	which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame containing a PERR
1906  *	element
1907  * @dot11MeshHWMPnetDiameterTraversalTime: the interval of time (in TUs) that
1908  *	it takes for an HWMP information element to propagate across the mesh
1909  * @dot11MeshHWMPRootMode: the configuration of a mesh STA as root mesh STA
1910  * @dot11MeshHWMPRannInterval: the interval of time (in TUs) between root
1911  *	announcements are transmitted
1912  * @dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol: whether to advertise that this mesh
1913  *	station has access to a broader network beyond the MBSS. (This is
1914  *	missnamed in draft 12.0: dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol set to true
1915  *	only means that the station will announce others it's a mesh gate, but
1916  *	not necessarily using the gate announcement protocol. Still keeping the
1917  *	same nomenclature to be in sync with the spec)
1918  * @dot11MeshForwarding: whether the Mesh STA is forwarding or non-forwarding
1919  *	entity (default is TRUE - forwarding entity)
1920  * @rssi_threshold: the threshold for average signal strength of candidate
1921  *	station to establish a peer link
1922  * @ht_opmode: mesh HT protection mode
1923  *
1924  * @dot11MeshHWMPactivePathToRootTimeout: The time (in TUs) for which mesh STAs
1925  *	receiving a proactive PREQ shall consider the forwarding information to
1926  *	the root mesh STA to be valid.
1927  *
1928  * @dot11MeshHWMProotInterval: The interval of time (in TUs) between proactive
1929  *	PREQs are transmitted.
1930  * @dot11MeshHWMPconfirmationInterval: The minimum interval of time (in TUs)
1931  *	during which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame containing
1932  *	a PREQ element for root path confirmation.
1933  * @power_mode: The default mesh power save mode which will be the initial
1934  *	setting for new peer links.
1935  * @dot11MeshAwakeWindowDuration: The duration in TUs the STA will remain awake
1936  *	after transmitting its beacon.
1937  * @plink_timeout: If no tx activity is seen from a STA we've established
1938  *	peering with for longer than this time (in seconds), then remove it
1939  *	from the STA's list of peers.  Default is 30 minutes.
1940  * @dot11MeshConnectedToMeshGate: if set to true, advertise that this STA is
1941  *      connected to a mesh gate in mesh formation info.  If false, the
1942  *      value in mesh formation is determined by the presence of root paths
1943  *      in the mesh path table
1944  * @dot11MeshNolearn: Try to avoid multi-hop path discovery (e.g. PREQ/PREP
1945  *      for HWMP) if the destination is a direct neighbor. Note that this might
1946  *      not be the optimal decision as a multi-hop route might be better. So
1947  *      if using this setting you will likely also want to disable
1948  *      dot11MeshForwarding and use another mesh routing protocol on top.
1949  */
1950 struct mesh_config {
1951 	u16 dot11MeshRetryTimeout;
1952 	u16 dot11MeshConfirmTimeout;
1953 	u16 dot11MeshHoldingTimeout;
1954 	u16 dot11MeshMaxPeerLinks;
1955 	u8 dot11MeshMaxRetries;
1956 	u8 dot11MeshTTL;
1957 	u8 element_ttl;
1958 	bool auto_open_plinks;
1959 	u32 dot11MeshNbrOffsetMaxNeighbor;
1960 	u8 dot11MeshHWMPmaxPREQretries;
1961 	u32 path_refresh_time;
1962 	u16 min_discovery_timeout;
1963 	u32 dot11MeshHWMPactivePathTimeout;
1964 	u16 dot11MeshHWMPpreqMinInterval;
1965 	u16 dot11MeshHWMPperrMinInterval;
1966 	u16 dot11MeshHWMPnetDiameterTraversalTime;
1967 	u8 dot11MeshHWMPRootMode;
1968 	bool dot11MeshConnectedToMeshGate;
1969 	bool dot11MeshConnectedToAuthServer;
1970 	u16 dot11MeshHWMPRannInterval;
1971 	bool dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol;
1972 	bool dot11MeshForwarding;
1973 	s32 rssi_threshold;
1974 	u16 ht_opmode;
1975 	u32 dot11MeshHWMPactivePathToRootTimeout;
1976 	u16 dot11MeshHWMProotInterval;
1977 	u16 dot11MeshHWMPconfirmationInterval;
1978 	enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode power_mode;
1979 	u16 dot11MeshAwakeWindowDuration;
1980 	u32 plink_timeout;
1981 	bool dot11MeshNolearn;
1982 };
1983 
1984 /**
1985  * struct mesh_setup - 802.11s mesh setup configuration
1986  * @chandef: defines the channel to use
1987  * @mesh_id: the mesh ID
1988  * @mesh_id_len: length of the mesh ID, at least 1 and at most 32 bytes
1989  * @sync_method: which synchronization method to use
1990  * @path_sel_proto: which path selection protocol to use
1991  * @path_metric: which metric to use
1992  * @auth_id: which authentication method this mesh is using
1993  * @ie: vendor information elements (optional)
1994  * @ie_len: length of vendor information elements
1995  * @is_authenticated: this mesh requires authentication
1996  * @is_secure: this mesh uses security
1997  * @user_mpm: userspace handles all MPM functions
1998  * @dtim_period: DTIM period to use
1999  * @beacon_interval: beacon interval to use
2000  * @mcast_rate: multicat rate for Mesh Node [6Mbps is the default for 802.11a]
2001  * @basic_rates: basic rates to use when creating the mesh
2002  * @beacon_rate: bitrate to be used for beacons
2003  * @userspace_handles_dfs: whether user space controls DFS operation, i.e.
2004  *	changes the channel when a radar is detected. This is required
2005  *	to operate on DFS channels.
2006  * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control
2007  *	port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface.
2008  *
2009  * These parameters are fixed when the mesh is created.
2010  */
2011 struct mesh_setup {
2012 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
2013 	const u8 *mesh_id;
2014 	u8 mesh_id_len;
2015 	u8 sync_method;
2016 	u8 path_sel_proto;
2017 	u8 path_metric;
2018 	u8 auth_id;
2019 	const u8 *ie;
2020 	u8 ie_len;
2021 	bool is_authenticated;
2022 	bool is_secure;
2023 	bool user_mpm;
2024 	u8 dtim_period;
2025 	u16 beacon_interval;
2026 	int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2027 	u32 basic_rates;
2028 	struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_rate;
2029 	bool userspace_handles_dfs;
2030 	bool control_port_over_nl80211;
2031 };
2032 
2033 /**
2034  * struct ocb_setup - 802.11p OCB mode setup configuration
2035  * @chandef: defines the channel to use
2036  *
2037  * These parameters are fixed when connecting to the network
2038  */
2039 struct ocb_setup {
2040 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
2041 };
2042 
2043 /**
2044  * struct ieee80211_txq_params - TX queue parameters
2045  * @ac: AC identifier
2046  * @txop: Maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning disabled
2047  * @cwmin: Minimum contention window [a value of the form 2^n-1 in the range
2048  *	1..32767]
2049  * @cwmax: Maximum contention window [a value of the form 2^n-1 in the range
2050  *	1..32767]
2051  * @aifs: Arbitration interframe space [0..255]
2052  */
2053 struct ieee80211_txq_params {
2054 	enum nl80211_ac ac;
2055 	u16 txop;
2056 	u16 cwmin;
2057 	u16 cwmax;
2058 	u8 aifs;
2059 };
2060 
2061 /**
2062  * DOC: Scanning and BSS list handling
2063  *
2064  * The scanning process itself is fairly simple, but cfg80211 offers quite
2065  * a bit of helper functionality. To start a scan, the scan operation will
2066  * be invoked with a scan definition. This scan definition contains the
2067  * channels to scan, and the SSIDs to send probe requests for (including the
2068  * wildcard, if desired). A passive scan is indicated by having no SSIDs to
2069  * probe. Additionally, a scan request may contain extra information elements
2070  * that should be added to the probe request. The IEs are guaranteed to be
2071  * well-formed, and will not exceed the maximum length the driver advertised
2072  * in the wiphy structure.
2073  *
2074  * When scanning finds a BSS, cfg80211 needs to be notified of that, because
2075  * it is responsible for maintaining the BSS list; the driver should not
2076  * maintain a list itself. For this notification, various functions exist.
2077  *
2078  * Since drivers do not maintain a BSS list, there are also a number of
2079  * functions to search for a BSS and obtain information about it from the
2080  * BSS structure cfg80211 maintains. The BSS list is also made available
2081  * to userspace.
2082  */
2083 
2084 /**
2085  * struct cfg80211_ssid - SSID description
2086  * @ssid: the SSID
2087  * @ssid_len: length of the ssid
2088  */
2089 struct cfg80211_ssid {
2090 	u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
2091 	u8 ssid_len;
2092 };
2093 
2094 /**
2095  * struct cfg80211_scan_info - information about completed scan
2096  * @scan_start_tsf: scan start time in terms of the TSF of the BSS that the
2097  *	wireless device that requested the scan is connected to. If this
2098  *	information is not available, this field is left zero.
2099  * @tsf_bssid: the BSSID according to which %scan_start_tsf is set.
2100  * @aborted: set to true if the scan was aborted for any reason,
2101  *	userspace will be notified of that
2102  */
2103 struct cfg80211_scan_info {
2104 	u64 scan_start_tsf;
2105 	u8 tsf_bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2106 	bool aborted;
2107 };
2108 
2109 /**
2110  * struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params - relevant for 6 GHz only
2111  *
2112  * @short_bssid: short ssid to scan for
2113  * @bssid: bssid to scan for
2114  * @channel_idx: idx of the channel in the channel array in the scan request
2115  *	 which the above info relvant to
2116  * @unsolicited_probe: the AP transmits unsolicited probe response every 20 TU
2117  * @short_ssid_valid: short_ssid is valid and can be used
2118  * @psc_no_listen: when set, and the channel is a PSC channel, no need to wait
2119  *       20 TUs before starting to send probe requests.
2120  */
2121 struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params {
2122 	u32 short_ssid;
2123 	u32 channel_idx;
2124 	u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN];
2125 	bool unsolicited_probe;
2126 	bool short_ssid_valid;
2127 	bool psc_no_listen;
2128 };
2129 
2130 /**
2131  * struct cfg80211_scan_request - scan request description
2132  *
2133  * @ssids: SSIDs to scan for (active scan only)
2134  * @n_ssids: number of SSIDs
2135  * @channels: channels to scan on.
2136  * @n_channels: total number of channels to scan
2137  * @scan_width: channel width for scanning
2138  * @ie: optional information element(s) to add into Probe Request or %NULL
2139  * @ie_len: length of ie in octets
2140  * @duration: how long to listen on each channel, in TUs. If
2141  *	%duration_mandatory is not set, this is the maximum dwell time and
2142  *	the actual dwell time may be shorter.
2143  * @duration_mandatory: if set, the scan duration must be as specified by the
2144  *	%duration field.
2145  * @flags: bit field of flags controlling operation
2146  * @rates: bitmap of rates to advertise for each band
2147  * @wiphy: the wiphy this was for
2148  * @scan_start: time (in jiffies) when the scan started
2149  * @wdev: the wireless device to scan for
2150  * @info: (internal) information about completed scan
2151  * @notified: (internal) scan request was notified as done or aborted
2152  * @no_cck: used to send probe requests at non CCK rate in 2GHz band
2153  * @mac_addr: MAC address used with randomisation
2154  * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used with randomisation, bits that
2155  *	are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should
2156  *	be taken from the @mac_addr
2157  * @scan_6ghz: relevant for split scan request only,
2158  *	true if this is the second scan request
2159  * @n_6ghz_params: number of 6 GHz params
2160  * @scan_6ghz_params: 6 GHz params
2161  * @bssid: BSSID to scan for (most commonly, the wildcard BSSID)
2162  */
2163 struct cfg80211_scan_request {
2164 	struct cfg80211_ssid *ssids;
2165 	int n_ssids;
2166 	u32 n_channels;
2167 	enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width;
2168 	const u8 *ie;
2169 	size_t ie_len;
2170 	u16 duration;
2171 	bool duration_mandatory;
2172 	u32 flags;
2173 
2174 	u32 rates[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2175 
2176 	struct wireless_dev *wdev;
2177 
2178 	u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2179 	u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2180 	u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2181 
2182 	/* internal */
2183 	struct wiphy *wiphy;
2184 	unsigned long scan_start;
2185 	struct cfg80211_scan_info info;
2186 	bool notified;
2187 	bool no_cck;
2188 	bool scan_6ghz;
2189 	u32 n_6ghz_params;
2190 	struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params *scan_6ghz_params;
2191 
2192 	/* keep last */
2193 	struct ieee80211_channel *channels[];
2194 };
2195 
get_random_mask_addr(u8 * buf,const u8 * addr,const u8 * mask)2196 static inline void get_random_mask_addr(u8 *buf, const u8 *addr, const u8 *mask)
2197 {
2198 	int i;
2199 
2200 	get_random_bytes(buf, ETH_ALEN);
2201 	for (i = 0; i < ETH_ALEN; i++) {
2202 		buf[i] &= ~mask[i];
2203 		buf[i] |= addr[i] & mask[i];
2204 	}
2205 }
2206 
2207 /**
2208  * struct cfg80211_match_set - sets of attributes to match
2209  *
2210  * @ssid: SSID to be matched; may be zero-length in case of BSSID match
2211  *	or no match (RSSI only)
2212  * @bssid: BSSID to be matched; may be all-zero BSSID in case of SSID match
2213  *	or no match (RSSI only)
2214  * @rssi_thold: don't report scan results below this threshold (in s32 dBm)
2215  * @per_band_rssi_thold: Minimum rssi threshold for each band to be applied
2216  *	for filtering out scan results received. Drivers advertize this support
2217  *	of band specific rssi based filtering through the feature capability
2218  *	%NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_BAND_SPECIFIC_RSSI_THOLD. These band
2219  *	specific rssi thresholds take precedence over rssi_thold, if specified.
2220  *	If not specified for any band, it will be assigned with rssi_thold of
2221  *	corresponding matchset.
2222  */
2223 struct cfg80211_match_set {
2224 	struct cfg80211_ssid ssid;
2225 	u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN];
2226 	s32 rssi_thold;
2227 	s32 per_band_rssi_thold[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2228 };
2229 
2230 /**
2231  * struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan - scan plan for scheduled scan
2232  *
2233  * @interval: interval between scheduled scan iterations. In seconds.
2234  * @iterations: number of scan iterations in this scan plan. Zero means
2235  *	infinite loop.
2236  *	The last scan plan will always have this parameter set to zero,
2237  *	all other scan plans will have a finite number of iterations.
2238  */
2239 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan {
2240 	u32 interval;
2241 	u32 iterations;
2242 };
2243 
2244 /**
2245  * struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust - BSS selection with RSSI adjustment.
2246  *
2247  * @band: band of BSS which should match for RSSI level adjustment.
2248  * @delta: value of RSSI level adjustment.
2249  */
2250 struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust {
2251 	enum nl80211_band band;
2252 	s8 delta;
2253 };
2254 
2255 /**
2256  * struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request - scheduled scan request description
2257  *
2258  * @reqid: identifies this request.
2259  * @ssids: SSIDs to scan for (passed in the probe_reqs in active scans)
2260  * @n_ssids: number of SSIDs
2261  * @n_channels: total number of channels to scan
2262  * @scan_width: channel width for scanning
2263  * @ie: optional information element(s) to add into Probe Request or %NULL
2264  * @ie_len: length of ie in octets
2265  * @flags: bit field of flags controlling operation
2266  * @match_sets: sets of parameters to be matched for a scan result
2267  *	entry to be considered valid and to be passed to the host
2268  *	(others are filtered out).
2269  *	If ommited, all results are passed.
2270  * @n_match_sets: number of match sets
2271  * @report_results: indicates that results were reported for this request
2272  * @wiphy: the wiphy this was for
2273  * @dev: the interface
2274  * @scan_start: start time of the scheduled scan
2275  * @channels: channels to scan
2276  * @min_rssi_thold: for drivers only supporting a single threshold, this
2277  *	contains the minimum over all matchsets
2278  * @mac_addr: MAC address used with randomisation
2279  * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used with randomisation, bits that
2280  *	are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should
2281  *	be taken from the @mac_addr
2282  * @scan_plans: scan plans to be executed in this scheduled scan. Lowest
2283  *	index must be executed first.
2284  * @n_scan_plans: number of scan plans, at least 1.
2285  * @rcu_head: RCU callback used to free the struct
2286  * @owner_nlportid: netlink portid of owner (if this should is a request
2287  *	owned by a particular socket)
2288  * @nl_owner_dead: netlink owner socket was closed - this request be freed
2289  * @list: for keeping list of requests.
2290  * @delay: delay in seconds to use before starting the first scan
2291  *	cycle.  The driver may ignore this parameter and start
2292  *	immediately (or at any other time), if this feature is not
2293  *	supported.
2294  * @relative_rssi_set: Indicates whether @relative_rssi is set or not.
2295  * @relative_rssi: Relative RSSI threshold in dB to restrict scan result
2296  *	reporting in connected state to cases where a matching BSS is determined
2297  *	to have better or slightly worse RSSI than the current connected BSS.
2298  *	The relative RSSI threshold values are ignored in disconnected state.
2299  * @rssi_adjust: delta dB of RSSI preference to be given to the BSSs that belong
2300  *	to the specified band while deciding whether a better BSS is reported
2301  *	using @relative_rssi. If delta is a negative number, the BSSs that
2302  *	belong to the specified band will be penalized by delta dB in relative
2303  *	comparisions.
2304  */
2305 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request {
2306 	u64 reqid;
2307 	struct cfg80211_ssid *ssids;
2308 	int n_ssids;
2309 	u32 n_channels;
2310 	enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width;
2311 	const u8 *ie;
2312 	size_t ie_len;
2313 	u32 flags;
2314 	struct cfg80211_match_set *match_sets;
2315 	int n_match_sets;
2316 	s32 min_rssi_thold;
2317 	u32 delay;
2318 	struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan *scan_plans;
2319 	int n_scan_plans;
2320 
2321 	u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2322 	u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2323 
2324 	bool relative_rssi_set;
2325 	s8 relative_rssi;
2326 	struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust rssi_adjust;
2327 
2328 	/* internal */
2329 	struct wiphy *wiphy;
2330 	struct net_device *dev;
2331 	unsigned long scan_start;
2332 	bool report_results;
2333 	struct rcu_head rcu_head;
2334 	u32 owner_nlportid;
2335 	bool nl_owner_dead;
2336 	struct list_head list;
2337 
2338 	/* keep last */
2339 	struct ieee80211_channel *channels[];
2340 };
2341 
2342 /**
2343  * enum cfg80211_signal_type - signal type
2344  *
2345  * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_NONE: no signal strength information available
2346  * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM: signal strength in mBm (100*dBm)
2347  * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_UNSPEC: signal strength, increasing from 0 through 100
2348  */
2349 enum cfg80211_signal_type {
2350 	CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_NONE,
2351 	CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM,
2352 	CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_UNSPEC,
2353 };
2354 
2355 /**
2356  * struct cfg80211_inform_bss - BSS inform data
2357  * @chan: channel the frame was received on
2358  * @scan_width: scan width that was used
2359  * @signal: signal strength value, according to the wiphy's
2360  *	signal type
2361  * @boottime_ns: timestamp (CLOCK_BOOTTIME) when the information was
2362  *	received; should match the time when the frame was actually
2363  *	received by the device (not just by the host, in case it was
2364  *	buffered on the device) and be accurate to about 10ms.
2365  *	If the frame isn't buffered, just passing the return value of
2366  *	ktime_get_boottime_ns() is likely appropriate.
2367  * @parent_tsf: the time at the start of reception of the first octet of the
2368  *	timestamp field of the frame. The time is the TSF of the BSS specified
2369  *	by %parent_bssid.
2370  * @parent_bssid: the BSS according to which %parent_tsf is set. This is set to
2371  *	the BSS that requested the scan in which the beacon/probe was received.
2372  * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal.
2373  * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received BSS in dBm.
2374  */
2375 struct cfg80211_inform_bss {
2376 	struct ieee80211_channel *chan;
2377 	enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width;
2378 	s32 signal;
2379 	u64 boottime_ns;
2380 	u64 parent_tsf;
2381 	u8 parent_bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2382 	u8 chains;
2383 	s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
2384 };
2385 
2386 /**
2387  * struct cfg80211_bss_ies - BSS entry IE data
2388  * @tsf: TSF contained in the frame that carried these IEs
2389  * @rcu_head: internal use, for freeing
2390  * @len: length of the IEs
2391  * @from_beacon: these IEs are known to come from a beacon
2392  * @data: IE data
2393  */
2394 struct cfg80211_bss_ies {
2395 	u64 tsf;
2396 	struct rcu_head rcu_head;
2397 	int len;
2398 	bool from_beacon;
2399 	u8 data[];
2400 };
2401 
2402 /**
2403  * struct cfg80211_bss - BSS description
2404  *
2405  * This structure describes a BSS (which may also be a mesh network)
2406  * for use in scan results and similar.
2407  *
2408  * @channel: channel this BSS is on
2409  * @scan_width: width of the control channel
2410  * @bssid: BSSID of the BSS
2411  * @beacon_interval: the beacon interval as from the frame
2412  * @capability: the capability field in host byte order
2413  * @ies: the information elements (Note that there is no guarantee that these
2414  *	are well-formed!); this is a pointer to either the beacon_ies or
2415  *	proberesp_ies depending on whether Probe Response frame has been
2416  *	received. It is always non-%NULL.
2417  * @beacon_ies: the information elements from the last Beacon frame
2418  *	(implementation note: if @hidden_beacon_bss is set this struct doesn't
2419  *	own the beacon_ies, but they're just pointers to the ones from the
2420  *	@hidden_beacon_bss struct)
2421  * @proberesp_ies: the information elements from the last Probe Response frame
2422  * @hidden_beacon_bss: in case this BSS struct represents a probe response from
2423  *	a BSS that hides the SSID in its beacon, this points to the BSS struct
2424  *	that holds the beacon data. @beacon_ies is still valid, of course, and
2425  *	points to the same data as hidden_beacon_bss->beacon_ies in that case.
2426  * @transmitted_bss: pointer to the transmitted BSS, if this is a
2427  *	non-transmitted one (multi-BSSID support)
2428  * @nontrans_list: list of non-transmitted BSS, if this is a transmitted one
2429  *	(multi-BSSID support)
2430  * @signal: signal strength value (type depends on the wiphy's signal_type)
2431  * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal.
2432  * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received BSS in dBm.
2433  * @bssid_index: index in the multiple BSS set
2434  * @max_bssid_indicator: max number of members in the BSS set
2435  * @priv: private area for driver use, has at least wiphy->bss_priv_size bytes
2436  */
2437 struct cfg80211_bss {
2438 	struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
2439 	enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width;
2440 
2441 	const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *ies;
2442 	const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *beacon_ies;
2443 	const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *proberesp_ies;
2444 
2445 	struct cfg80211_bss *hidden_beacon_bss;
2446 	struct cfg80211_bss *transmitted_bss;
2447 	struct list_head nontrans_list;
2448 
2449 	s32 signal;
2450 
2451 	u16 beacon_interval;
2452 	u16 capability;
2453 
2454 	u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN];
2455 	u8 chains;
2456 	s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
2457 
2458 	u8 bssid_index;
2459 	u8 max_bssid_indicator;
2460 
2461 	u8 priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2462 };
2463 
2464 /**
2465  * ieee80211_bss_get_elem - find element with given ID
2466  * @bss: the bss to search
2467  * @id: the element ID
2468  *
2469  * Note that the return value is an RCU-protected pointer, so
2470  * rcu_read_lock() must be held when calling this function.
2471  * Return: %NULL if not found.
2472  */
2473 const struct element *ieee80211_bss_get_elem(struct cfg80211_bss *bss, u8 id);
2474 
2475 /**
2476  * ieee80211_bss_get_ie - find IE with given ID
2477  * @bss: the bss to search
2478  * @id: the element ID
2479  *
2480  * Note that the return value is an RCU-protected pointer, so
2481  * rcu_read_lock() must be held when calling this function.
2482  * Return: %NULL if not found.
2483  */
ieee80211_bss_get_ie(struct cfg80211_bss * bss,u8 id)2484 static inline const u8 *ieee80211_bss_get_ie(struct cfg80211_bss *bss, u8 id)
2485 {
2486 	return (void *)ieee80211_bss_get_elem(bss, id);
2487 }
2488 
2489 
2490 /**
2491  * struct cfg80211_auth_request - Authentication request data
2492  *
2493  * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
2494  * authentication.
2495  *
2496  * @bss: The BSS to authenticate with, the callee must obtain a reference
2497  *	to it if it needs to keep it.
2498  * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm)
2499  * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Authentication frame or %NULL
2500  * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets
2501  * @key_len: length of WEP key for shared key authentication
2502  * @key_idx: index of WEP key for shared key authentication
2503  * @key: WEP key for shared key authentication
2504  * @auth_data: Fields and elements in Authentication frames. This contains
2505  *	the authentication frame body (non-IE and IE data), excluding the
2506  *	Authentication algorithm number, i.e., starting at the Authentication
2507  *	transaction sequence number field.
2508  * @auth_data_len: Length of auth_data buffer in octets
2509  */
2510 struct cfg80211_auth_request {
2511 	struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
2512 	const u8 *ie;
2513 	size_t ie_len;
2514 	enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type;
2515 	const u8 *key;
2516 	u8 key_len, key_idx;
2517 	const u8 *auth_data;
2518 	size_t auth_data_len;
2519 };
2520 
2521 /**
2522  * enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags - Over-ride default behaviour in association.
2523  *
2524  * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HT:  Disable HT (802.11n)
2525  * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_VHT:  Disable VHT
2526  * @ASSOC_REQ_USE_RRM: Declare RRM capability in this association
2527  * @CONNECT_REQ_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT: User space indicates external
2528  *	authentication capability. Drivers can offload authentication to
2529  *	userspace if this flag is set. Only applicable for cfg80211_connect()
2530  *	request (connect callback).
2531  */
2532 enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags {
2533 	ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HT			= BIT(0),
2534 	ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_VHT			= BIT(1),
2535 	ASSOC_REQ_USE_RRM			= BIT(2),
2536 	CONNECT_REQ_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT	= BIT(3),
2537 };
2538 
2539 /**
2540  * struct cfg80211_assoc_request - (Re)Association request data
2541  *
2542  * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
2543  * (re)association.
2544  * @bss: The BSS to associate with. If the call is successful the driver is
2545  *	given a reference that it must give back to cfg80211_send_rx_assoc()
2546  *	or to cfg80211_assoc_timeout(). To ensure proper refcounting, new
2547  *	association requests while already associating must be rejected.
2548  * @ie: Extra IEs to add to (Re)Association Request frame or %NULL
2549  * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets
2550  * @use_mfp: Use management frame protection (IEEE 802.11w) in this association
2551  * @crypto: crypto settings
2552  * @prev_bssid: previous BSSID, if not %NULL use reassociate frame. This is used
2553  *	to indicate a request to reassociate within the ESS instead of a request
2554  *	do the initial association with the ESS. When included, this is set to
2555  *	the BSSID of the current association, i.e., to the value that is
2556  *	included in the Current AP address field of the Reassociation Request
2557  *	frame.
2558  * @flags:  See &enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags
2559  * @ht_capa:  HT Capabilities over-rides.  Values set in ht_capa_mask
2560  *	will be used in ht_capa.  Un-supported values will be ignored.
2561  * @ht_capa_mask:  The bits of ht_capa which are to be used.
2562  * @vht_capa: VHT capability override
2563  * @vht_capa_mask: VHT capability mask indicating which fields to use
2564  * @fils_kek: FILS KEK for protecting (Re)Association Request/Response frame or
2565  *	%NULL if FILS is not used.
2566  * @fils_kek_len: Length of fils_kek in octets
2567  * @fils_nonces: FILS nonces (part of AAD) for protecting (Re)Association
2568  *	Request/Response frame or %NULL if FILS is not used. This field starts
2569  *	with 16 octets of STA Nonce followed by 16 octets of AP Nonce.
2570  * @s1g_capa: S1G capability override
2571  * @s1g_capa_mask: S1G capability override mask
2572  */
2573 struct cfg80211_assoc_request {
2574 	struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
2575 	const u8 *ie, *prev_bssid;
2576 	size_t ie_len;
2577 	struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto;
2578 	bool use_mfp;
2579 	u32 flags;
2580 	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa;
2581 	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask;
2582 	struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa, vht_capa_mask;
2583 	const u8 *fils_kek;
2584 	size_t fils_kek_len;
2585 	const u8 *fils_nonces;
2586 	struct ieee80211_s1g_cap s1g_capa, s1g_capa_mask;
2587 };
2588 
2589 /**
2590  * struct cfg80211_deauth_request - Deauthentication request data
2591  *
2592  * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
2593  * deauthentication.
2594  *
2595  * @bssid: the BSSID of the BSS to deauthenticate from
2596  * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Deauthentication frame or %NULL
2597  * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets
2598  * @reason_code: The reason code for the deauthentication
2599  * @local_state_change: if set, change local state only and
2600  *	do not set a deauth frame
2601  */
2602 struct cfg80211_deauth_request {
2603 	const u8 *bssid;
2604 	const u8 *ie;
2605 	size_t ie_len;
2606 	u16 reason_code;
2607 	bool local_state_change;
2608 };
2609 
2610 /**
2611  * struct cfg80211_disassoc_request - Disassociation request data
2612  *
2613  * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
2614  * disassociation.
2615  *
2616  * @bss: the BSS to disassociate from
2617  * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Disassociation frame or %NULL
2618  * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets
2619  * @reason_code: The reason code for the disassociation
2620  * @local_state_change: This is a request for a local state only, i.e., no
2621  *	Disassociation frame is to be transmitted.
2622  */
2623 struct cfg80211_disassoc_request {
2624 	struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
2625 	const u8 *ie;
2626 	size_t ie_len;
2627 	u16 reason_code;
2628 	bool local_state_change;
2629 };
2630 
2631 /**
2632  * struct cfg80211_ibss_params - IBSS parameters
2633  *
2634  * This structure defines the IBSS parameters for the join_ibss()
2635  * method.
2636  *
2637  * @ssid: The SSID, will always be non-null.
2638  * @ssid_len: The length of the SSID, will always be non-zero.
2639  * @bssid: Fixed BSSID requested, maybe be %NULL, if set do not
2640  *	search for IBSSs with a different BSSID.
2641  * @chandef: defines the channel to use if no other IBSS to join can be found
2642  * @channel_fixed: The channel should be fixed -- do not search for
2643  *	IBSSs to join on other channels.
2644  * @ie: information element(s) to include in the beacon
2645  * @ie_len: length of that
2646  * @beacon_interval: beacon interval to use
2647  * @privacy: this is a protected network, keys will be configured
2648  *	after joining
2649  * @control_port: whether user space controls IEEE 802.1X port, i.e.,
2650  *	sets/clears %NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED. If true, the driver is
2651  *	required to assume that the port is unauthorized until authorized by
2652  *	user space. Otherwise, port is marked authorized by default.
2653  * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control
2654  *	port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface.
2655  * @userspace_handles_dfs: whether user space controls DFS operation, i.e.
2656  *	changes the channel when a radar is detected. This is required
2657  *	to operate on DFS channels.
2658  * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates to use when creating the IBSS
2659  * @mcast_rate: per-band multicast rate index + 1 (0: disabled)
2660  * @ht_capa:  HT Capabilities over-rides.  Values set in ht_capa_mask
2661  *	will be used in ht_capa.  Un-supported values will be ignored.
2662  * @ht_capa_mask:  The bits of ht_capa which are to be used.
2663  * @wep_keys: static WEP keys, if not NULL points to an array of
2664  *	CFG80211_MAX_WEP_KEYS WEP keys
2665  * @wep_tx_key: key index (0..3) of the default TX static WEP key
2666  */
2667 struct cfg80211_ibss_params {
2668 	const u8 *ssid;
2669 	const u8 *bssid;
2670 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
2671 	const u8 *ie;
2672 	u8 ssid_len, ie_len;
2673 	u16 beacon_interval;
2674 	u32 basic_rates;
2675 	bool channel_fixed;
2676 	bool privacy;
2677 	bool control_port;
2678 	bool control_port_over_nl80211;
2679 	bool userspace_handles_dfs;
2680 	int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2681 	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa;
2682 	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask;
2683 	struct key_params *wep_keys;
2684 	int wep_tx_key;
2685 };
2686 
2687 /**
2688  * struct cfg80211_bss_selection - connection parameters for BSS selection.
2689  *
2690  * @behaviour: requested BSS selection behaviour.
2691  * @param: parameters for requestion behaviour.
2692  * @band_pref: preferred band for %NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_BAND_PREF.
2693  * @adjust: parameters for %NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST.
2694  */
2695 struct cfg80211_bss_selection {
2696 	enum nl80211_bss_select_attr behaviour;
2697 	union {
2698 		enum nl80211_band band_pref;
2699 		struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust adjust;
2700 	} param;
2701 };
2702 
2703 /**
2704  * struct cfg80211_connect_params - Connection parameters
2705  *
2706  * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
2707  * authentication and association.
2708  *
2709  * @channel: The channel to use or %NULL if not specified (auto-select based
2710  *	on scan results)
2711  * @channel_hint: The channel of the recommended BSS for initial connection or
2712  *	%NULL if not specified
2713  * @bssid: The AP BSSID or %NULL if not specified (auto-select based on scan
2714  *	results)
2715  * @bssid_hint: The recommended AP BSSID for initial connection to the BSS or
2716  *	%NULL if not specified. Unlike the @bssid parameter, the driver is
2717  *	allowed to ignore this @bssid_hint if it has knowledge of a better BSS
2718  *	to use.
2719  * @ssid: SSID
2720  * @ssid_len: Length of ssid in octets
2721  * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm)
2722  * @ie: IEs for association request
2723  * @ie_len: Length of assoc_ie in octets
2724  * @privacy: indicates whether privacy-enabled APs should be used
2725  * @mfp: indicate whether management frame protection is used
2726  * @crypto: crypto settings
2727  * @key_len: length of WEP key for shared key authentication
2728  * @key_idx: index of WEP key for shared key authentication
2729  * @key: WEP key for shared key authentication
2730  * @flags:  See &enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags
2731  * @bg_scan_period:  Background scan period in seconds
2732  *	or -1 to indicate that default value is to be used.
2733  * @ht_capa:  HT Capabilities over-rides.  Values set in ht_capa_mask
2734  *	will be used in ht_capa.  Un-supported values will be ignored.
2735  * @ht_capa_mask:  The bits of ht_capa which are to be used.
2736  * @vht_capa:  VHT Capability overrides
2737  * @vht_capa_mask: The bits of vht_capa which are to be used.
2738  * @pbss: if set, connect to a PCP instead of AP. Valid for DMG
2739  *	networks.
2740  * @bss_select: criteria to be used for BSS selection.
2741  * @prev_bssid: previous BSSID, if not %NULL use reassociate frame. This is used
2742  *	to indicate a request to reassociate within the ESS instead of a request
2743  *	do the initial association with the ESS. When included, this is set to
2744  *	the BSSID of the current association, i.e., to the value that is
2745  *	included in the Current AP address field of the Reassociation Request
2746  *	frame.
2747  * @fils_erp_username: EAP re-authentication protocol (ERP) username part of the
2748  *	NAI or %NULL if not specified. This is used to construct FILS wrapped
2749  *	data IE.
2750  * @fils_erp_username_len: Length of @fils_erp_username in octets.
2751  * @fils_erp_realm: EAP re-authentication protocol (ERP) realm part of NAI or
2752  *	%NULL if not specified. This specifies the domain name of ER server and
2753  *	is used to construct FILS wrapped data IE.
2754  * @fils_erp_realm_len: Length of @fils_erp_realm in octets.
2755  * @fils_erp_next_seq_num: The next sequence number to use in the FILS ERP
2756  *	messages. This is also used to construct FILS wrapped data IE.
2757  * @fils_erp_rrk: ERP re-authentication Root Key (rRK) used to derive additional
2758  *	keys in FILS or %NULL if not specified.
2759  * @fils_erp_rrk_len: Length of @fils_erp_rrk in octets.
2760  * @want_1x: indicates user-space supports and wants to use 802.1X driver
2761  *	offload of 4-way handshake.
2762  * @edmg: define the EDMG channels.
2763  *	This may specify multiple channels and bonding options for the driver
2764  *	to choose from, based on BSS configuration.
2765  */
2766 struct cfg80211_connect_params {
2767 	struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
2768 	struct ieee80211_channel *channel_hint;
2769 	const u8 *bssid;
2770 	const u8 *bssid_hint;
2771 	const u8 *ssid;
2772 	size_t ssid_len;
2773 	enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type;
2774 	const u8 *ie;
2775 	size_t ie_len;
2776 	bool privacy;
2777 	enum nl80211_mfp mfp;
2778 	struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto;
2779 	const u8 *key;
2780 	u8 key_len, key_idx;
2781 	u32 flags;
2782 	int bg_scan_period;
2783 	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa;
2784 	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask;
2785 	struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa;
2786 	struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa_mask;
2787 	bool pbss;
2788 	struct cfg80211_bss_selection bss_select;
2789 	const u8 *prev_bssid;
2790 	const u8 *fils_erp_username;
2791 	size_t fils_erp_username_len;
2792 	const u8 *fils_erp_realm;
2793 	size_t fils_erp_realm_len;
2794 	u16 fils_erp_next_seq_num;
2795 	const u8 *fils_erp_rrk;
2796 	size_t fils_erp_rrk_len;
2797 	bool want_1x;
2798 	struct ieee80211_edmg edmg;
2799 };
2800 
2801 /**
2802  * enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed - Connection parameters being updated
2803  *
2804  * This enum provides information of all connect parameters that
2805  * have to be updated as part of update_connect_params() call.
2806  *
2807  * @UPDATE_ASSOC_IES: Indicates whether association request IEs are updated
2808  * @UPDATE_FILS_ERP_INFO: Indicates that FILS connection parameters (realm,
2809  *	username, erp sequence number and rrk) are updated
2810  * @UPDATE_AUTH_TYPE: Indicates that authentication type is updated
2811  */
2812 enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed {
2813 	UPDATE_ASSOC_IES		= BIT(0),
2814 	UPDATE_FILS_ERP_INFO		= BIT(1),
2815 	UPDATE_AUTH_TYPE		= BIT(2),
2816 };
2817 
2818 /**
2819  * enum wiphy_params_flags - set_wiphy_params bitfield values
2820  * @WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_SHORT: wiphy->retry_short has changed
2821  * @WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_LONG: wiphy->retry_long has changed
2822  * @WIPHY_PARAM_FRAG_THRESHOLD: wiphy->frag_threshold has changed
2823  * @WIPHY_PARAM_RTS_THRESHOLD: wiphy->rts_threshold has changed
2824  * @WIPHY_PARAM_COVERAGE_CLASS: coverage class changed
2825  * @WIPHY_PARAM_DYN_ACK: dynack has been enabled
2826  * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_LIMIT: TXQ packet limit has been changed
2827  * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT: TXQ memory limit has been changed
2828  * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_QUANTUM: TXQ scheduler quantum
2829  */
2830 enum wiphy_params_flags {
2831 	WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_SHORT		= 1 << 0,
2832 	WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_LONG		= 1 << 1,
2833 	WIPHY_PARAM_FRAG_THRESHOLD	= 1 << 2,
2834 	WIPHY_PARAM_RTS_THRESHOLD	= 1 << 3,
2835 	WIPHY_PARAM_COVERAGE_CLASS	= 1 << 4,
2836 	WIPHY_PARAM_DYN_ACK		= 1 << 5,
2837 	WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_LIMIT		= 1 << 6,
2838 	WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT	= 1 << 7,
2839 	WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_QUANTUM		= 1 << 8,
2840 };
2841 
2842 #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AIRTIME_WEIGHT	256
2843 
2844 /* The per TXQ device queue limit in airtime */
2845 #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AQL_TXQ_LIMIT_L	5000
2846 #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AQL_TXQ_LIMIT_H	12000
2847 
2848 /* The per interface airtime threshold to switch to lower queue limit */
2849 #define IEEE80211_AQL_THRESHOLD			24000
2850 
2851 /**
2852  * struct cfg80211_pmksa - PMK Security Association
2853  *
2854  * This structure is passed to the set/del_pmksa() method for PMKSA
2855  * caching.
2856  *
2857  * @bssid: The AP's BSSID (may be %NULL).
2858  * @pmkid: The identifier to refer a PMKSA.
2859  * @pmk: The PMK for the PMKSA identified by @pmkid. This is used for key
2860  *	derivation by a FILS STA. Otherwise, %NULL.
2861  * @pmk_len: Length of the @pmk. The length of @pmk can differ depending on
2862  *	the hash algorithm used to generate this.
2863  * @ssid: SSID to specify the ESS within which a PMKSA is valid when using FILS
2864  *	cache identifier (may be %NULL).
2865  * @ssid_len: Length of the @ssid in octets.
2866  * @cache_id: 2-octet cache identifier advertized by a FILS AP identifying the
2867  *	scope of PMKSA. This is valid only if @ssid_len is non-zero (may be
2868  *	%NULL).
2869  * @pmk_lifetime: Maximum lifetime for PMKSA in seconds
2870  *	(dot11RSNAConfigPMKLifetime) or 0 if not specified.
2871  *	The configured PMKSA must not be used for PMKSA caching after
2872  *	expiration and any keys derived from this PMK become invalid on
2873  *	expiration, i.e., the current association must be dropped if the PMK
2874  *	used for it expires.
2875  * @pmk_reauth_threshold: Threshold time for reauthentication (percentage of
2876  *	PMK lifetime, dot11RSNAConfigPMKReauthThreshold) or 0 if not specified.
2877  *	Drivers are expected to trigger a full authentication instead of using
2878  *	this PMKSA for caching when reassociating to a new BSS after this
2879  *	threshold to generate a new PMK before the current one expires.
2880  */
2881 struct cfg80211_pmksa {
2882 	const u8 *bssid;
2883 	const u8 *pmkid;
2884 	const u8 *pmk;
2885 	size_t pmk_len;
2886 	const u8 *ssid;
2887 	size_t ssid_len;
2888 	const u8 *cache_id;
2889 	u32 pmk_lifetime;
2890 	u8 pmk_reauth_threshold;
2891 };
2892 
2893 /**
2894  * struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern - packet pattern
2895  * @mask: bitmask where to match pattern and where to ignore bytes,
2896  *	one bit per byte, in same format as nl80211
2897  * @pattern: bytes to match where bitmask is 1
2898  * @pattern_len: length of pattern (in bytes)
2899  * @pkt_offset: packet offset (in bytes)
2900  *
2901  * Internal note: @mask and @pattern are allocated in one chunk of
2902  * memory, free @mask only!
2903  */
2904 struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern {
2905 	const u8 *mask, *pattern;
2906 	int pattern_len;
2907 	int pkt_offset;
2908 };
2909 
2910 /**
2911  * struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp - TCP connection parameters
2912  *
2913  * @sock: (internal) socket for source port allocation
2914  * @src: source IP address
2915  * @dst: destination IP address
2916  * @dst_mac: destination MAC address
2917  * @src_port: source port
2918  * @dst_port: destination port
2919  * @payload_len: data payload length
2920  * @payload: data payload buffer
2921  * @payload_seq: payload sequence stamping configuration
2922  * @data_interval: interval at which to send data packets
2923  * @wake_len: wakeup payload match length
2924  * @wake_data: wakeup payload match data
2925  * @wake_mask: wakeup payload match mask
2926  * @tokens_size: length of the tokens buffer
2927  * @payload_tok: payload token usage configuration
2928  */
2929 struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp {
2930 	struct socket *sock;
2931 	__be32 src, dst;
2932 	u16 src_port, dst_port;
2933 	u8 dst_mac[ETH_ALEN];
2934 	int payload_len;
2935 	const u8 *payload;
2936 	struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq payload_seq;
2937 	u32 data_interval;
2938 	u32 wake_len;
2939 	const u8 *wake_data, *wake_mask;
2940 	u32 tokens_size;
2941 	/* must be last, variable member */
2942 	struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token payload_tok;
2943 };
2944 
2945 /**
2946  * struct cfg80211_wowlan - Wake on Wireless-LAN support info
2947  *
2948  * This structure defines the enabled WoWLAN triggers for the device.
2949  * @any: wake up on any activity -- special trigger if device continues
2950  *	operating as normal during suspend
2951  * @disconnect: wake up if getting disconnected
2952  * @magic_pkt: wake up on receiving magic packet
2953  * @patterns: wake up on receiving packet matching a pattern
2954  * @n_patterns: number of patterns
2955  * @gtk_rekey_failure: wake up on GTK rekey failure
2956  * @eap_identity_req: wake up on EAP identity request packet
2957  * @four_way_handshake: wake up on 4-way handshake
2958  * @rfkill_release: wake up when rfkill is released
2959  * @tcp: TCP connection establishment/wakeup parameters, see nl80211.h.
2960  *	NULL if not configured.
2961  * @nd_config: configuration for the scan to be used for net detect wake.
2962  */
2963 struct cfg80211_wowlan {
2964 	bool any, disconnect, magic_pkt, gtk_rekey_failure,
2965 	     eap_identity_req, four_way_handshake,
2966 	     rfkill_release;
2967 	struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern *patterns;
2968 	struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp *tcp;
2969 	int n_patterns;
2970 	struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *nd_config;
2971 };
2972 
2973 /**
2974  * struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules - Coalesce rule parameters
2975  *
2976  * This structure defines coalesce rule for the device.
2977  * @delay: maximum coalescing delay in msecs.
2978  * @condition: condition for packet coalescence.
2979  *	see &enum nl80211_coalesce_condition.
2980  * @patterns: array of packet patterns
2981  * @n_patterns: number of patterns
2982  */
2983 struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules {
2984 	int delay;
2985 	enum nl80211_coalesce_condition condition;
2986 	struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern *patterns;
2987 	int n_patterns;
2988 };
2989 
2990 /**
2991  * struct cfg80211_coalesce - Packet coalescing settings
2992  *
2993  * This structure defines coalescing settings.
2994  * @rules: array of coalesce rules
2995  * @n_rules: number of rules
2996  */
2997 struct cfg80211_coalesce {
2998 	struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules *rules;
2999 	int n_rules;
3000 };
3001 
3002 /**
3003  * struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match - information about the match
3004  *
3005  * @ssid: SSID of the match that triggered the wake up
3006  * @n_channels: Number of channels where the match occurred.  This
3007  *	value may be zero if the driver can't report the channels.
3008  * @channels: center frequencies of the channels where a match
3009  *	occurred (in MHz)
3010  */
3011 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match {
3012 	struct cfg80211_ssid ssid;
3013 	int n_channels;
3014 	u32 channels[];
3015 };
3016 
3017 /**
3018  * struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info - net detect wake up information
3019  *
3020  * @n_matches: Number of match information instances provided in
3021  *	@matches.  This value may be zero if the driver can't provide
3022  *	match information.
3023  * @matches: Array of pointers to matches containing information about
3024  *	the matches that triggered the wake up.
3025  */
3026 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info {
3027 	int n_matches;
3028 	struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match *matches[];
3029 };
3030 
3031 /**
3032  * struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup - wakeup report
3033  * @disconnect: woke up by getting disconnected
3034  * @magic_pkt: woke up by receiving magic packet
3035  * @gtk_rekey_failure: woke up by GTK rekey failure
3036  * @eap_identity_req: woke up by EAP identity request packet
3037  * @four_way_handshake: woke up by 4-way handshake
3038  * @rfkill_release: woke up by rfkill being released
3039  * @pattern_idx: pattern that caused wakeup, -1 if not due to pattern
3040  * @packet_present_len: copied wakeup packet data
3041  * @packet_len: original wakeup packet length
3042  * @packet: The packet causing the wakeup, if any.
3043  * @packet_80211:  For pattern match, magic packet and other data
3044  *	frame triggers an 802.3 frame should be reported, for
3045  *	disconnect due to deauth 802.11 frame. This indicates which
3046  *	it is.
3047  * @tcp_match: TCP wakeup packet received
3048  * @tcp_connlost: TCP connection lost or failed to establish
3049  * @tcp_nomoretokens: TCP data ran out of tokens
3050  * @net_detect: if not %NULL, woke up because of net detect
3051  */
3052 struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup {
3053 	bool disconnect, magic_pkt, gtk_rekey_failure,
3054 	     eap_identity_req, four_way_handshake,
3055 	     rfkill_release, packet_80211,
3056 	     tcp_match, tcp_connlost, tcp_nomoretokens;
3057 	s32 pattern_idx;
3058 	u32 packet_present_len, packet_len;
3059 	const void *packet;
3060 	struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info *net_detect;
3061 };
3062 
3063 /**
3064  * struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data - rekey data
3065  * @kek: key encryption key (@kek_len bytes)
3066  * @kck: key confirmation key (@kck_len bytes)
3067  * @replay_ctr: replay counter (NL80211_REPLAY_CTR_LEN bytes)
3068  * @kek_len: length of kek
3069  * @kck_len length of kck
3070  * @akm: akm (oui, id)
3071  */
3072 struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data {
3073 	const u8 *kek, *kck, *replay_ctr;
3074 	u32 akm;
3075 	u8 kek_len, kck_len;
3076 };
3077 
3078 /**
3079  * struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params - FT IE Information
3080  *
3081  * This structure provides information needed to update the fast transition IE
3082  *
3083  * @md: The Mobility Domain ID, 2 Octet value
3084  * @ie: Fast Transition IEs
3085  * @ie_len: Length of ft_ie in octets
3086  */
3087 struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params {
3088 	u16 md;
3089 	const u8 *ie;
3090 	size_t ie_len;
3091 };
3092 
3093 /**
3094  * struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params - mgmt tx parameters
3095  *
3096  * This structure provides information needed to transmit a mgmt frame
3097  *
3098  * @chan: channel to use
3099  * @offchan: indicates wether off channel operation is required
3100  * @wait: duration for ROC
3101  * @buf: buffer to transmit
3102  * @len: buffer length
3103  * @no_cck: don't use cck rates for this frame
3104  * @dont_wait_for_ack: tells the low level not to wait for an ack
3105  * @n_csa_offsets: length of csa_offsets array
3106  * @csa_offsets: array of all the csa offsets in the frame
3107  */
3108 struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params {
3109 	struct ieee80211_channel *chan;
3110 	bool offchan;
3111 	unsigned int wait;
3112 	const u8 *buf;
3113 	size_t len;
3114 	bool no_cck;
3115 	bool dont_wait_for_ack;
3116 	int n_csa_offsets;
3117 	const u16 *csa_offsets;
3118 };
3119 
3120 /**
3121  * struct cfg80211_dscp_exception - DSCP exception
3122  *
3123  * @dscp: DSCP value that does not adhere to the user priority range definition
3124  * @up: user priority value to which the corresponding DSCP value belongs
3125  */
3126 struct cfg80211_dscp_exception {
3127 	u8 dscp;
3128 	u8 up;
3129 };
3130 
3131 /**
3132  * struct cfg80211_dscp_range - DSCP range definition for user priority
3133  *
3134  * @low: lowest DSCP value of this user priority range, inclusive
3135  * @high: highest DSCP value of this user priority range, inclusive
3136  */
3137 struct cfg80211_dscp_range {
3138 	u8 low;
3139 	u8 high;
3140 };
3141 
3142 /* QoS Map Set element length defined in IEEE Std 802.11-2012, 8.4.2.97 */
3143 #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX	21
3144 #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MIN	16
3145 #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MAX \
3146 	(IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MIN + 2 * IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX)
3147 
3148 /**
3149  * struct cfg80211_qos_map - QoS Map Information
3150  *
3151  * This struct defines the Interworking QoS map setting for DSCP values
3152  *
3153  * @num_des: number of DSCP exceptions (0..21)
3154  * @dscp_exception: optionally up to maximum of 21 DSCP exceptions from
3155  *	the user priority DSCP range definition
3156  * @up: DSCP range definition for a particular user priority
3157  */
3158 struct cfg80211_qos_map {
3159 	u8 num_des;
3160 	struct cfg80211_dscp_exception dscp_exception[IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX];
3161 	struct cfg80211_dscp_range up[8];
3162 };
3163 
3164 /**
3165  * struct cfg80211_nan_conf - NAN configuration
3166  *
3167  * This struct defines NAN configuration parameters
3168  *
3169  * @master_pref: master preference (1 - 255)
3170  * @bands: operating bands, a bitmap of &enum nl80211_band values.
3171  *	For instance, for NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, bit 0 would be set
3172  *	(i.e. BIT(NL80211_BAND_2GHZ)).
3173  */
3174 struct cfg80211_nan_conf {
3175 	u8 master_pref;
3176 	u8 bands;
3177 };
3178 
3179 /**
3180  * enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes - indicates changed fields in NAN
3181  * configuration
3182  *
3183  * @CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_PREF: master preference
3184  * @CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_BANDS: operating bands
3185  */
3186 enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes {
3187 	CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_PREF = BIT(0),
3188 	CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_BANDS = BIT(1),
3189 };
3190 
3191 /**
3192  * struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter - a NAN function Rx / Tx filter
3193  *
3194  * @filter: the content of the filter
3195  * @len: the length of the filter
3196  */
3197 struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter {
3198 	const u8 *filter;
3199 	u8 len;
3200 };
3201 
3202 /**
3203  * struct cfg80211_nan_func - a NAN function
3204  *
3205  * @type: &enum nl80211_nan_function_type
3206  * @service_id: the service ID of the function
3207  * @publish_type: &nl80211_nan_publish_type
3208  * @close_range: if true, the range should be limited. Threshold is
3209  *	implementation specific.
3210  * @publish_bcast: if true, the solicited publish should be broadcasted
3211  * @subscribe_active: if true, the subscribe is active
3212  * @followup_id: the instance ID for follow up
3213  * @followup_reqid: the requestor instance ID for follow up
3214  * @followup_dest: MAC address of the recipient of the follow up
3215  * @ttl: time to live counter in DW.
3216  * @serv_spec_info: Service Specific Info
3217  * @serv_spec_info_len: Service Specific Info length
3218  * @srf_include: if true, SRF is inclusive
3219  * @srf_bf: Bloom Filter
3220  * @srf_bf_len: Bloom Filter length
3221  * @srf_bf_idx: Bloom Filter index
3222  * @srf_macs: SRF MAC addresses
3223  * @srf_num_macs: number of MAC addresses in SRF
3224  * @rx_filters: rx filters that are matched with corresponding peer's tx_filter
3225  * @tx_filters: filters that should be transmitted in the SDF.
3226  * @num_rx_filters: length of &rx_filters.
3227  * @num_tx_filters: length of &tx_filters.
3228  * @instance_id: driver allocated id of the function.
3229  * @cookie: unique NAN function identifier.
3230  */
3231 struct cfg80211_nan_func {
3232 	enum nl80211_nan_function_type type;
3233 	u8 service_id[NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID_LEN];
3234 	u8 publish_type;
3235 	bool close_range;
3236 	bool publish_bcast;
3237 	bool subscribe_active;
3238 	u8 followup_id;
3239 	u8 followup_reqid;
3240 	struct mac_address followup_dest;
3241 	u32 ttl;
3242 	const u8 *serv_spec_info;
3243 	u8 serv_spec_info_len;
3244 	bool srf_include;
3245 	const u8 *srf_bf;
3246 	u8 srf_bf_len;
3247 	u8 srf_bf_idx;
3248 	struct mac_address *srf_macs;
3249 	int srf_num_macs;
3250 	struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter *rx_filters;
3251 	struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter *tx_filters;
3252 	u8 num_tx_filters;
3253 	u8 num_rx_filters;
3254 	u8 instance_id;
3255 	u64 cookie;
3256 };
3257 
3258 /**
3259  * struct cfg80211_pmk_conf - PMK configuration
3260  *
3261  * @aa: authenticator address
3262  * @pmk_len: PMK length in bytes.
3263  * @pmk: the PMK material
3264  * @pmk_r0_name: PMK-R0 Name. NULL if not applicable (i.e., the PMK
3265  *	is not PMK-R0). When pmk_r0_name is not NULL, the pmk field
3266  *	holds PMK-R0.
3267  */
3268 struct cfg80211_pmk_conf {
3269 	const u8 *aa;
3270 	u8 pmk_len;
3271 	const u8 *pmk;
3272 	const u8 *pmk_r0_name;
3273 };
3274 
3275 /**
3276  * struct cfg80211_external_auth_params - Trigger External authentication.
3277  *
3278  * Commonly used across the external auth request and event interfaces.
3279  *
3280  * @action: action type / trigger for external authentication. Only significant
3281  *	for the authentication request event interface (driver to user space).
3282  * @bssid: BSSID of the peer with which the authentication has
3283  *	to happen. Used by both the authentication request event and
3284  *	authentication response command interface.
3285  * @ssid: SSID of the AP.  Used by both the authentication request event and
3286  *	authentication response command interface.
3287  * @key_mgmt_suite: AKM suite of the respective authentication. Used by the
3288  *	authentication request event interface.
3289  * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful authentication,
3290  *	use %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if user space cannot give you
3291  *	the real status code for failures. Used only for the authentication
3292  *	response command interface (user space to driver).
3293  * @pmkid: The identifier to refer a PMKSA.
3294  */
3295 struct cfg80211_external_auth_params {
3296 	enum nl80211_external_auth_action action;
3297 	u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
3298 	struct cfg80211_ssid ssid;
3299 	unsigned int key_mgmt_suite;
3300 	u16 status;
3301 	const u8 *pmkid;
3302 };
3303 
3304 /**
3305  * struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats - FTM responder statistics
3306  *
3307  * @filled: bitflag of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_ftm_stats to
3308  *	indicate the relevant values in this struct for them
3309  * @success_num: number of FTM sessions in which all frames were successfully
3310  *	answered
3311  * @partial_num: number of FTM sessions in which part of frames were
3312  *	successfully answered
3313  * @failed_num: number of failed FTM sessions
3314  * @asap_num: number of ASAP FTM sessions
3315  * @non_asap_num: number of  non-ASAP FTM sessions
3316  * @total_duration_ms: total sessions durations - gives an indication
3317  *	of how much time the responder was busy
3318  * @unknown_triggers_num: number of unknown FTM triggers - triggers from
3319  *	initiators that didn't finish successfully the negotiation phase with
3320  *	the responder
3321  * @reschedule_requests_num: number of FTM reschedule requests - initiator asks
3322  *	for a new scheduling although it already has scheduled FTM slot
3323  * @out_of_window_triggers_num: total FTM triggers out of scheduled window
3324  */
3325 struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats {
3326 	u32 filled;
3327 	u32 success_num;
3328 	u32 partial_num;
3329 	u32 failed_num;
3330 	u32 asap_num;
3331 	u32 non_asap_num;
3332 	u64 total_duration_ms;
3333 	u32 unknown_triggers_num;
3334 	u32 reschedule_requests_num;
3335 	u32 out_of_window_triggers_num;
3336 };
3337 
3338 /**
3339  * struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result - FTM result
3340  * @failure_reason: if this measurement failed (PMSR status is
3341  *	%NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_FAILURE), this gives a more precise
3342  *	reason than just "failure"
3343  * @burst_index: if reporting partial results, this is the index
3344  *	in [0 .. num_bursts-1] of the burst that's being reported
3345  * @num_ftmr_attempts: number of FTM request frames transmitted
3346  * @num_ftmr_successes: number of FTM request frames acked
3347  * @busy_retry_time: if failure_reason is %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_BUSY,
3348  *	fill this to indicate in how many seconds a retry is deemed possible
3349  *	by the responder
3350  * @num_bursts_exp: actual number of bursts exponent negotiated
3351  * @burst_duration: actual burst duration negotiated
3352  * @ftms_per_burst: actual FTMs per burst negotiated
3353  * @lci_len: length of LCI information (if present)
3354  * @civicloc_len: length of civic location information (if present)
3355  * @lci: LCI data (may be %NULL)
3356  * @civicloc: civic location data (may be %NULL)
3357  * @rssi_avg: average RSSI over FTM action frames reported
3358  * @rssi_spread: spread of the RSSI over FTM action frames reported
3359  * @tx_rate: bitrate for transmitted FTM action frame response
3360  * @rx_rate: bitrate of received FTM action frame
3361  * @rtt_avg: average of RTTs measured (must have either this or @dist_avg)
3362  * @rtt_variance: variance of RTTs measured (note that standard deviation is
3363  *	the square root of the variance)
3364  * @rtt_spread: spread of the RTTs measured
3365  * @dist_avg: average of distances (mm) measured
3366  *	(must have either this or @rtt_avg)
3367  * @dist_variance: variance of distances measured (see also @rtt_variance)
3368  * @dist_spread: spread of distances measured (see also @rtt_spread)
3369  * @num_ftmr_attempts_valid: @num_ftmr_attempts is valid
3370  * @num_ftmr_successes_valid: @num_ftmr_successes is valid
3371  * @rssi_avg_valid: @rssi_avg is valid
3372  * @rssi_spread_valid: @rssi_spread is valid
3373  * @tx_rate_valid: @tx_rate is valid
3374  * @rx_rate_valid: @rx_rate is valid
3375  * @rtt_avg_valid: @rtt_avg is valid
3376  * @rtt_variance_valid: @rtt_variance is valid
3377  * @rtt_spread_valid: @rtt_spread is valid
3378  * @dist_avg_valid: @dist_avg is valid
3379  * @dist_variance_valid: @dist_variance is valid
3380  * @dist_spread_valid: @dist_spread is valid
3381  */
3382 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result {
3383 	const u8 *lci;
3384 	const u8 *civicloc;
3385 	unsigned int lci_len;
3386 	unsigned int civicloc_len;
3387 	enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_failure_reasons failure_reason;
3388 	u32 num_ftmr_attempts, num_ftmr_successes;
3389 	s16 burst_index;
3390 	u8 busy_retry_time;
3391 	u8 num_bursts_exp;
3392 	u8 burst_duration;
3393 	u8 ftms_per_burst;
3394 	s32 rssi_avg;
3395 	s32 rssi_spread;
3396 	struct rate_info tx_rate, rx_rate;
3397 	s64 rtt_avg;
3398 	s64 rtt_variance;
3399 	s64 rtt_spread;
3400 	s64 dist_avg;
3401 	s64 dist_variance;
3402 	s64 dist_spread;
3403 
3404 	u16 num_ftmr_attempts_valid:1,
3405 	    num_ftmr_successes_valid:1,
3406 	    rssi_avg_valid:1,
3407 	    rssi_spread_valid:1,
3408 	    tx_rate_valid:1,
3409 	    rx_rate_valid:1,
3410 	    rtt_avg_valid:1,
3411 	    rtt_variance_valid:1,
3412 	    rtt_spread_valid:1,
3413 	    dist_avg_valid:1,
3414 	    dist_variance_valid:1,
3415 	    dist_spread_valid:1;
3416 };
3417 
3418 /**
3419  * struct cfg80211_pmsr_result - peer measurement result
3420  * @addr: address of the peer
3421  * @host_time: host time (use ktime_get_boottime() adjust to the time when the
3422  *	measurement was made)
3423  * @ap_tsf: AP's TSF at measurement time
3424  * @status: status of the measurement
3425  * @final: if reporting partial results, mark this as the last one; if not
3426  *	reporting partial results always set this flag
3427  * @ap_tsf_valid: indicates the @ap_tsf value is valid
3428  * @type: type of the measurement reported, note that we only support reporting
3429  *	one type at a time, but you can report multiple results separately and
3430  *	they're all aggregated for userspace.
3431  */
3432 struct cfg80211_pmsr_result {
3433 	u64 host_time, ap_tsf;
3434 	enum nl80211_peer_measurement_status status;
3435 
3436 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
3437 
3438 	u8 final:1,
3439 	   ap_tsf_valid:1;
3440 
3441 	enum nl80211_peer_measurement_type type;
3442 
3443 	union {
3444 		struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result ftm;
3445 	};
3446 };
3447 
3448 /**
3449  * struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer - FTM request data
3450  * @requested: indicates FTM is requested
3451  * @preamble: frame preamble to use
3452  * @burst_period: burst period to use
3453  * @asap: indicates to use ASAP mode
3454  * @num_bursts_exp: number of bursts exponent
3455  * @burst_duration: burst duration
3456  * @ftms_per_burst: number of FTMs per burst
3457  * @ftmr_retries: number of retries for FTM request
3458  * @request_lci: request LCI information
3459  * @request_civicloc: request civic location information
3460  * @trigger_based: use trigger based ranging for the measurement
3461  *		 If neither @trigger_based nor @non_trigger_based is set,
3462  *		 EDCA based ranging will be used.
3463  * @non_trigger_based: use non trigger based ranging for the measurement
3464  *		 If neither @trigger_based nor @non_trigger_based is set,
3465  *		 EDCA based ranging will be used.
3466  *
3467  * See also nl80211 for the respective attribute documentation.
3468  */
3469 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer {
3470 	enum nl80211_preamble preamble;
3471 	u16 burst_period;
3472 	u8 requested:1,
3473 	   asap:1,
3474 	   request_lci:1,
3475 	   request_civicloc:1,
3476 	   trigger_based:1,
3477 	   non_trigger_based:1;
3478 	u8 num_bursts_exp;
3479 	u8 burst_duration;
3480 	u8 ftms_per_burst;
3481 	u8 ftmr_retries;
3482 };
3483 
3484 /**
3485  * struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer - peer data for a peer measurement request
3486  * @addr: MAC address
3487  * @chandef: channel to use
3488  * @report_ap_tsf: report the associated AP's TSF
3489  * @ftm: FTM data, see &struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer
3490  */
3491 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer {
3492 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
3493 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
3494 	u8 report_ap_tsf:1;
3495 	struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer ftm;
3496 };
3497 
3498 /**
3499  * struct cfg80211_pmsr_request - peer measurement request
3500  * @cookie: cookie, set by cfg80211
3501  * @nl_portid: netlink portid - used by cfg80211
3502  * @drv_data: driver data for this request, if required for aborting,
3503  *	not otherwise freed or anything by cfg80211
3504  * @mac_addr: MAC address used for (randomised) request
3505  * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used for randomisation, bits that
3506  *	are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should
3507  *	be taken from the @mac_addr
3508  * @list: used by cfg80211 to hold on to the request
3509  * @timeout: timeout (in milliseconds) for the whole operation, if
3510  *	zero it means there's no timeout
3511  * @n_peers: number of peers to do measurements with
3512  * @peers: per-peer measurement request data
3513  */
3514 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request {
3515 	u64 cookie;
3516 	void *drv_data;
3517 	u32 n_peers;
3518 	u32 nl_portid;
3519 
3520 	u32 timeout;
3521 
3522 	u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
3523 	u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
3524 
3525 	struct list_head list;
3526 
3527 	struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer peers[];
3528 };
3529 
3530 /**
3531  * struct cfg80211_update_owe_info - OWE Information
3532  *
3533  * This structure provides information needed for the drivers to offload OWE
3534  * (Opportunistic Wireless Encryption) processing to the user space.
3535  *
3536  * Commonly used across update_owe_info request and event interfaces.
3537  *
3538  * @peer: MAC address of the peer device for which the OWE processing
3539  *	has to be done.
3540  * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful OWE info
3541  *	processing, use %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if user space
3542  *	cannot give you the real status code for failures. Used only for
3543  *	OWE update request command interface (user space to driver).
3544  * @ie: IEs obtained from the peer or constructed by the user space. These are
3545  *	the IEs of the remote peer in the event from the host driver and
3546  *	the constructed IEs by the user space in the request interface.
3547  * @ie_len: Length of IEs in octets.
3548  */
3549 struct cfg80211_update_owe_info {
3550 	u8 peer[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
3551 	u16 status;
3552 	const u8 *ie;
3553 	size_t ie_len;
3554 };
3555 
3556 /**
3557  * struct mgmt_frame_regs - management frame registrations data
3558  * @global_stypes: bitmap of management frame subtypes registered
3559  *	for the entire device
3560  * @interface_stypes: bitmap of management frame subtypes registered
3561  *	for the given interface
3562  * @global_mcast_rx: mcast RX is needed globally for these subtypes
3563  * @interface_mcast_stypes: mcast RX is needed on this interface
3564  *	for these subtypes
3565  */
3566 struct mgmt_frame_regs {
3567 	u32 global_stypes, interface_stypes;
3568 	u32 global_mcast_stypes, interface_mcast_stypes;
3569 };
3570 
3571 /**
3572  * struct cfg80211_ops - backend description for wireless configuration
3573  *
3574  * This struct is registered by fullmac card drivers and/or wireless stacks
3575  * in order to handle configuration requests on their interfaces.
3576  *
3577  * All callbacks except where otherwise noted should return 0
3578  * on success or a negative error code.
3579  *
3580  * All operations are currently invoked under rtnl for consistency with the
3581  * wireless extensions but this is subject to reevaluation as soon as this
3582  * code is used more widely and we have a first user without wext.
3583  *
3584  * @suspend: wiphy device needs to be suspended. The variable @wow will
3585  *	be %NULL or contain the enabled Wake-on-Wireless triggers that are
3586  *	configured for the device.
3587  * @resume: wiphy device needs to be resumed
3588  * @set_wakeup: Called when WoWLAN is enabled/disabled, use this callback
3589  *	to call device_set_wakeup_enable() to enable/disable wakeup from
3590  *	the device.
3591  *
3592  * @add_virtual_intf: create a new virtual interface with the given name,
3593  *	must set the struct wireless_dev's iftype. Beware: You must create
3594  *	the new netdev in the wiphy's network namespace! Returns the struct
3595  *	wireless_dev, or an ERR_PTR. For P2P device wdevs, the driver must
3596  *	also set the address member in the wdev.
3597  *
3598  * @del_virtual_intf: remove the virtual interface
3599  *
3600  * @change_virtual_intf: change type/configuration of virtual interface,
3601  *	keep the struct wireless_dev's iftype updated.
3602  *
3603  * @add_key: add a key with the given parameters. @mac_addr will be %NULL
3604  *	when adding a group key.
3605  *
3606  * @get_key: get information about the key with the given parameters.
3607  *	@mac_addr will be %NULL when requesting information for a group
3608  *	key. All pointers given to the @callback function need not be valid
3609  *	after it returns. This function should return an error if it is
3610  *	not possible to retrieve the key, -ENOENT if it doesn't exist.
3611  *
3612  * @del_key: remove a key given the @mac_addr (%NULL for a group key)
3613  *	and @key_index, return -ENOENT if the key doesn't exist.
3614  *
3615  * @set_default_key: set the default key on an interface
3616  *
3617  * @set_default_mgmt_key: set the default management frame key on an interface
3618  *
3619  * @set_default_beacon_key: set the default Beacon frame key on an interface
3620  *
3621  * @set_rekey_data: give the data necessary for GTK rekeying to the driver
3622  *
3623  * @start_ap: Start acting in AP mode defined by the parameters.
3624  * @change_beacon: Change the beacon parameters for an access point mode
3625  *	interface. This should reject the call when AP mode wasn't started.
3626  * @stop_ap: Stop being an AP, including stopping beaconing.
3627  *
3628  * @add_station: Add a new station.
3629  * @del_station: Remove a station
3630  * @change_station: Modify a given station. Note that flags changes are not much
3631  *	validated in cfg80211, in particular the auth/assoc/authorized flags
3632  *	might come to the driver in invalid combinations -- make sure to check
3633  *	them, also against the existing state! Drivers must call
3634  *	cfg80211_check_station_change() to validate the information.
3635  * @get_station: get station information for the station identified by @mac
3636  * @dump_station: dump station callback -- resume dump at index @idx
3637  *
3638  * @add_mpath: add a fixed mesh path
3639  * @del_mpath: delete a given mesh path
3640  * @change_mpath: change a given mesh path
3641  * @get_mpath: get a mesh path for the given parameters
3642  * @dump_mpath: dump mesh path callback -- resume dump at index @idx
3643  * @get_mpp: get a mesh proxy path for the given parameters
3644  * @dump_mpp: dump mesh proxy path callback -- resume dump at index @idx
3645  * @join_mesh: join the mesh network with the specified parameters
3646  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3647  * @leave_mesh: leave the current mesh network
3648  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3649  *
3650  * @get_mesh_config: Get the current mesh configuration
3651  *
3652  * @update_mesh_config: Update mesh parameters on a running mesh.
3653  *	The mask is a bitfield which tells us which parameters to
3654  *	set, and which to leave alone.
3655  *
3656  * @change_bss: Modify parameters for a given BSS.
3657  *
3658  * @set_txq_params: Set TX queue parameters
3659  *
3660  * @libertas_set_mesh_channel: Only for backward compatibility for libertas,
3661  *	as it doesn't implement join_mesh and needs to set the channel to
3662  *	join the mesh instead.
3663  *
3664  * @set_monitor_channel: Set the monitor mode channel for the device. If other
3665  *	interfaces are active this callback should reject the configuration.
3666  *	If no interfaces are active or the device is down, the channel should
3667  *	be stored for when a monitor interface becomes active.
3668  *
3669  * @scan: Request to do a scan. If returning zero, the scan request is given
3670  *	the driver, and will be valid until passed to cfg80211_scan_done().
3671  *	For scan results, call cfg80211_inform_bss(); you can call this outside
3672  *	the scan/scan_done bracket too.
3673  * @abort_scan: Tell the driver to abort an ongoing scan. The driver shall
3674  *	indicate the status of the scan through cfg80211_scan_done().
3675  *
3676  * @auth: Request to authenticate with the specified peer
3677  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3678  * @assoc: Request to (re)associate with the specified peer
3679  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3680  * @deauth: Request to deauthenticate from the specified peer
3681  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3682  * @disassoc: Request to disassociate from the specified peer
3683  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3684  *
3685  * @connect: Connect to the ESS with the specified parameters. When connected,
3686  *	call cfg80211_connect_result()/cfg80211_connect_bss() with status code
3687  *	%WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS. If the connection fails for some reason, call
3688  *	cfg80211_connect_result()/cfg80211_connect_bss() with the status code
3689  *	from the AP or cfg80211_connect_timeout() if no frame with status code
3690  *	was received.
3691  *	The driver is allowed to roam to other BSSes within the ESS when the
3692  *	other BSS matches the connect parameters. When such roaming is initiated
3693  *	by the driver, the driver is expected to verify that the target matches
3694  *	the configured security parameters and to use Reassociation Request
3695  *	frame instead of Association Request frame.
3696  *	The connect function can also be used to request the driver to perform a
3697  *	specific roam when connected to an ESS. In that case, the prev_bssid
3698  *	parameter is set to the BSSID of the currently associated BSS as an
3699  *	indication of requesting reassociation.
3700  *	In both the driver-initiated and new connect() call initiated roaming
3701  *	cases, the result of roaming is indicated with a call to
3702  *	cfg80211_roamed(). (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3703  * @update_connect_params: Update the connect parameters while connected to a
3704  *	BSS. The updated parameters can be used by driver/firmware for
3705  *	subsequent BSS selection (roaming) decisions and to form the
3706  *	Authentication/(Re)Association Request frames. This call does not
3707  *	request an immediate disassociation or reassociation with the current
3708  *	BSS, i.e., this impacts only subsequent (re)associations. The bits in
3709  *	changed are defined in &enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed.
3710  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3711  * @disconnect: Disconnect from the BSS/ESS or stop connection attempts if
3712  *      connection is in progress. Once done, call cfg80211_disconnected() in
3713  *      case connection was already established (invoked with the
3714  *      wireless_dev mutex held), otherwise call cfg80211_connect_timeout().
3715  *
3716  * @join_ibss: Join the specified IBSS (or create if necessary). Once done, call
3717  *	cfg80211_ibss_joined(), also call that function when changing BSSID due
3718  *	to a merge.
3719  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3720  * @leave_ibss: Leave the IBSS.
3721  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3722  *
3723  * @set_mcast_rate: Set the specified multicast rate (only if vif is in ADHOC or
3724  *	MESH mode)
3725  *
3726  * @set_wiphy_params: Notify that wiphy parameters have changed;
3727  *	@changed bitfield (see &enum wiphy_params_flags) describes which values
3728  *	have changed. The actual parameter values are available in
3729  *	struct wiphy. If returning an error, no value should be changed.
3730  *
3731  * @set_tx_power: set the transmit power according to the parameters,
3732  *	the power passed is in mBm, to get dBm use MBM_TO_DBM(). The
3733  *	wdev may be %NULL if power was set for the wiphy, and will
3734  *	always be %NULL unless the driver supports per-vif TX power
3735  *	(as advertised by the nl80211 feature flag.)
3736  * @get_tx_power: store the current TX power into the dbm variable;
3737  *	return 0 if successful
3738  *
3739  * @set_wds_peer: set the WDS peer for a WDS interface
3740  *
3741  * @rfkill_poll: polls the hw rfkill line, use cfg80211 reporting
3742  *	functions to adjust rfkill hw state
3743  *
3744  * @dump_survey: get site survey information.
3745  *
3746  * @remain_on_channel: Request the driver to remain awake on the specified
3747  *	channel for the specified duration to complete an off-channel
3748  *	operation (e.g., public action frame exchange). When the driver is
3749  *	ready on the requested channel, it must indicate this with an event
3750  *	notification by calling cfg80211_ready_on_channel().
3751  * @cancel_remain_on_channel: Cancel an on-going remain-on-channel operation.
3752  *	This allows the operation to be terminated prior to timeout based on
3753  *	the duration value.
3754  * @mgmt_tx: Transmit a management frame.
3755  * @mgmt_tx_cancel_wait: Cancel the wait time from transmitting a management
3756  *	frame on another channel
3757  *
3758  * @testmode_cmd: run a test mode command; @wdev may be %NULL
3759  * @testmode_dump: Implement a test mode dump. The cb->args[2] and up may be
3760  *	used by the function, but 0 and 1 must not be touched. Additionally,
3761  *	return error codes other than -ENOBUFS and -ENOENT will terminate the
3762  *	dump and return to userspace with an error, so be careful. If any data
3763  *	was passed in from userspace then the data/len arguments will be present
3764  *	and point to the data contained in %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA.
3765  *
3766  * @set_bitrate_mask: set the bitrate mask configuration
3767  *
3768  * @set_pmksa: Cache a PMKID for a BSSID. This is mostly useful for fullmac
3769  *	devices running firmwares capable of generating the (re) association
3770  *	RSN IE. It allows for faster roaming between WPA2 BSSIDs.
3771  * @del_pmksa: Delete a cached PMKID.
3772  * @flush_pmksa: Flush all cached PMKIDs.
3773  * @set_power_mgmt: Configure WLAN power management. A timeout value of -1
3774  *	allows the driver to adjust the dynamic ps timeout value.
3775  * @set_cqm_rssi_config: Configure connection quality monitor RSSI threshold.
3776  *	After configuration, the driver should (soon) send an event indicating
3777  *	the current level is above/below the configured threshold; this may
3778  *	need some care when the configuration is changed (without first being
3779  *	disabled.)
3780  * @set_cqm_rssi_range_config: Configure two RSSI thresholds in the
3781  *	connection quality monitor.  An event is to be sent only when the
3782  *	signal level is found to be outside the two values.  The driver should
3783  *	set %NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST if this method is implemented.
3784  *	If it is provided then there's no point providing @set_cqm_rssi_config.
3785  * @set_cqm_txe_config: Configure connection quality monitor TX error
3786  *	thresholds.
3787  * @sched_scan_start: Tell the driver to start a scheduled scan.
3788  * @sched_scan_stop: Tell the driver to stop an ongoing scheduled scan with
3789  *	given request id. This call must stop the scheduled scan and be ready
3790  *	for starting a new one before it returns, i.e. @sched_scan_start may be
3791  *	called immediately after that again and should not fail in that case.
3792  *	The driver should not call cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped() for a requested
3793  *	stop (when this method returns 0).
3794  *
3795  * @update_mgmt_frame_registrations: Notify the driver that management frame
3796  *	registrations were updated. The callback is allowed to sleep.
3797  *
3798  * @set_antenna: Set antenna configuration (tx_ant, rx_ant) on the device.
3799  *	Parameters are bitmaps of allowed antennas to use for TX/RX. Drivers may
3800  *	reject TX/RX mask combinations they cannot support by returning -EINVAL
3801  *	(also see nl80211.h @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX).
3802  *
3803  * @get_antenna: Get current antenna configuration from device (tx_ant, rx_ant).
3804  *
3805  * @tdls_mgmt: Transmit a TDLS management frame.
3806  * @tdls_oper: Perform a high-level TDLS operation (e.g. TDLS link setup).
3807  *
3808  * @probe_client: probe an associated client, must return a cookie that it
3809  *	later passes to cfg80211_probe_status().
3810  *
3811  * @set_noack_map: Set the NoAck Map for the TIDs.
3812  *
3813  * @get_channel: Get the current operating channel for the virtual interface.
3814  *	For monitor interfaces, it should return %NULL unless there's a single
3815  *	current monitoring channel.
3816  *
3817  * @start_p2p_device: Start the given P2P device.
3818  * @stop_p2p_device: Stop the given P2P device.
3819  *
3820  * @set_mac_acl: Sets MAC address control list in AP and P2P GO mode.
3821  *	Parameters include ACL policy, an array of MAC address of stations
3822  *	and the number of MAC addresses. If there is already a list in driver
3823  *	this new list replaces the existing one. Driver has to clear its ACL
3824  *	when number of MAC addresses entries is passed as 0. Drivers which
3825  *	advertise the support for MAC based ACL have to implement this callback.
3826  *
3827  * @start_radar_detection: Start radar detection in the driver.
3828  *
3829  * @end_cac: End running CAC, probably because a related CAC
3830  *	was finished on another phy.
3831  *
3832  * @update_ft_ies: Provide updated Fast BSS Transition information to the
3833  *	driver. If the SME is in the driver/firmware, this information can be
3834  *	used in building Authentication and Reassociation Request frames.
3835  *
3836  * @crit_proto_start: Indicates a critical protocol needs more link reliability
3837  *	for a given duration (milliseconds). The protocol is provided so the
3838  *	driver can take the most appropriate actions.
3839  * @crit_proto_stop: Indicates critical protocol no longer needs increased link
3840  *	reliability. This operation can not fail.
3841  * @set_coalesce: Set coalesce parameters.
3842  *
3843  * @channel_switch: initiate channel-switch procedure (with CSA). Driver is
3844  *	responsible for veryfing if the switch is possible. Since this is
3845  *	inherently tricky driver may decide to disconnect an interface later
3846  *	with cfg80211_stop_iface(). This doesn't mean driver can accept
3847  *	everything. It should do it's best to verify requests and reject them
3848  *	as soon as possible.
3849  *
3850  * @set_qos_map: Set QoS mapping information to the driver
3851  *
3852  * @set_ap_chanwidth: Set the AP (including P2P GO) mode channel width for the
3853  *	given interface This is used e.g. for dynamic HT 20/40 MHz channel width
3854  *	changes during the lifetime of the BSS.
3855  *
3856  * @add_tx_ts: validate (if admitted_time is 0) or add a TX TS to the device
3857  *	with the given parameters; action frame exchange has been handled by
3858  *	userspace so this just has to modify the TX path to take the TS into
3859  *	account.
3860  *	If the admitted time is 0 just validate the parameters to make sure
3861  *	the session can be created at all; it is valid to just always return
3862  *	success for that but that may result in inefficient behaviour (handshake
3863  *	with the peer followed by immediate teardown when the addition is later
3864  *	rejected)
3865  * @del_tx_ts: remove an existing TX TS
3866  *
3867  * @join_ocb: join the OCB network with the specified parameters
3868  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3869  * @leave_ocb: leave the current OCB network
3870  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3871  *
3872  * @tdls_channel_switch: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer. The driver
3873  *	is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching operations
3874  *	and returning to the base channel for communication with the AP.
3875  * @tdls_cancel_channel_switch: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS peer. Both
3876  *	peers must be on the base channel when the call completes.
3877  * @start_nan: Start the NAN interface.
3878  * @stop_nan: Stop the NAN interface.
3879  * @add_nan_func: Add a NAN function. Returns negative value on failure.
3880  *	On success @nan_func ownership is transferred to the driver and
3881  *	it may access it outside of the scope of this function. The driver
3882  *	should free the @nan_func when no longer needed by calling
3883  *	cfg80211_free_nan_func().
3884  *	On success the driver should assign an instance_id in the
3885  *	provided @nan_func.
3886  * @del_nan_func: Delete a NAN function.
3887  * @nan_change_conf: changes NAN configuration. The changed parameters must
3888  *	be specified in @changes (using &enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes);
3889  *	All other parameters must be ignored.
3890  *
3891  * @set_multicast_to_unicast: configure multicast to unicast conversion for BSS
3892  *
3893  * @get_txq_stats: Get TXQ stats for interface or phy. If wdev is %NULL, this
3894  *      function should return phy stats, and interface stats otherwise.
3895  *
3896  * @set_pmk: configure the PMK to be used for offloaded 802.1X 4-Way handshake.
3897  *	If not deleted through @del_pmk the PMK remains valid until disconnect
3898  *	upon which the driver should clear it.
3899  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3900  * @del_pmk: delete the previously configured PMK for the given authenticator.
3901  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3902  *
3903  * @external_auth: indicates result of offloaded authentication processing from
3904  *     user space
3905  *
3906  * @tx_control_port: TX a control port frame (EAPoL).  The noencrypt parameter
3907  *	tells the driver that the frame should not be encrypted.
3908  *
3909  * @get_ftm_responder_stats: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, if available.
3910  *	Statistics should be cumulative, currently no way to reset is provided.
3911  * @start_pmsr: start peer measurement (e.g. FTM)
3912  * @abort_pmsr: abort peer measurement
3913  *
3914  * @update_owe_info: Provide updated OWE info to driver. Driver implementing SME
3915  *	but offloading OWE processing to the user space will get the updated
3916  *	DH IE through this interface.
3917  *
3918  * @probe_mesh_link: Probe direct Mesh peer's link quality by sending data frame
3919  *	and overrule HWMP path selection algorithm.
3920  * @set_tid_config: TID specific configuration, this can be peer or BSS specific
3921  *	This callback may sleep.
3922  * @reset_tid_config: Reset TID specific configuration for the peer, for the
3923  *	given TIDs. This callback may sleep.
3924  */
3925 struct cfg80211_ops {
3926 	int	(*suspend)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_wowlan *wow);
3927 	int	(*resume)(struct wiphy *wiphy);
3928 	void	(*set_wakeup)(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool enabled);
3929 
3930 	struct wireless_dev * (*add_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
3931 						  const char *name,
3932 						  unsigned char name_assign_type,
3933 						  enum nl80211_iftype type,
3934 						  struct vif_params *params);
3935 	int	(*del_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
3936 				    struct wireless_dev *wdev);
3937 	int	(*change_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
3938 				       struct net_device *dev,
3939 				       enum nl80211_iftype type,
3940 				       struct vif_params *params);
3941 
3942 	int	(*add_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
3943 			   u8 key_index, bool pairwise, const u8 *mac_addr,
3944 			   struct key_params *params);
3945 	int	(*get_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
3946 			   u8 key_index, bool pairwise, const u8 *mac_addr,
3947 			   void *cookie,
3948 			   void (*callback)(void *cookie, struct key_params*));
3949 	int	(*del_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
3950 			   u8 key_index, bool pairwise, const u8 *mac_addr);
3951 	int	(*set_default_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
3952 				   struct net_device *netdev,
3953 				   u8 key_index, bool unicast, bool multicast);
3954 	int	(*set_default_mgmt_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
3955 					struct net_device *netdev,
3956 					u8 key_index);
3957 	int	(*set_default_beacon_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
3958 					  struct net_device *netdev,
3959 					  u8 key_index);
3960 
3961 	int	(*start_ap)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3962 			    struct cfg80211_ap_settings *settings);
3963 	int	(*change_beacon)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3964 				 struct cfg80211_beacon_data *info);
3965 	int	(*stop_ap)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev);
3966 
3967 
3968 	int	(*add_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3969 			       const u8 *mac,
3970 			       struct station_parameters *params);
3971 	int	(*del_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3972 			       struct station_del_parameters *params);
3973 	int	(*change_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3974 				  const u8 *mac,
3975 				  struct station_parameters *params);
3976 	int	(*get_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3977 			       const u8 *mac, struct station_info *sinfo);
3978 	int	(*dump_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3979 				int idx, u8 *mac, struct station_info *sinfo);
3980 
3981 	int	(*add_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3982 			       const u8 *dst, const u8 *next_hop);
3983 	int	(*del_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3984 			       const u8 *dst);
3985 	int	(*change_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3986 				  const u8 *dst, const u8 *next_hop);
3987 	int	(*get_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3988 			     u8 *dst, u8 *next_hop, struct mpath_info *pinfo);
3989 	int	(*dump_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3990 			      int idx, u8 *dst, u8 *next_hop,
3991 			      struct mpath_info *pinfo);
3992 	int	(*get_mpp)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3993 			   u8 *dst, u8 *mpp, struct mpath_info *pinfo);
3994 	int	(*dump_mpp)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
3995 			    int idx, u8 *dst, u8 *mpp,
3996 			    struct mpath_info *pinfo);
3997 	int	(*get_mesh_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
3998 				struct net_device *dev,
3999 				struct mesh_config *conf);
4000 	int	(*update_mesh_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4001 				      struct net_device *dev, u32 mask,
4002 				      const struct mesh_config *nconf);
4003 	int	(*join_mesh)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4004 			     const struct mesh_config *conf,
4005 			     const struct mesh_setup *setup);
4006 	int	(*leave_mesh)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev);
4007 
4008 	int	(*join_ocb)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4009 			    struct ocb_setup *setup);
4010 	int	(*leave_ocb)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev);
4011 
4012 	int	(*change_bss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4013 			      struct bss_parameters *params);
4014 
4015 	int	(*set_txq_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4016 				  struct ieee80211_txq_params *params);
4017 
4018 	int	(*libertas_set_mesh_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4019 					     struct net_device *dev,
4020 					     struct ieee80211_channel *chan);
4021 
4022 	int	(*set_monitor_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4023 				       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4024 
4025 	int	(*scan)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4026 			struct cfg80211_scan_request *request);
4027 	void	(*abort_scan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4028 
4029 	int	(*auth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4030 			struct cfg80211_auth_request *req);
4031 	int	(*assoc)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4032 			 struct cfg80211_assoc_request *req);
4033 	int	(*deauth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4034 			  struct cfg80211_deauth_request *req);
4035 	int	(*disassoc)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4036 			    struct cfg80211_disassoc_request *req);
4037 
4038 	int	(*connect)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4039 			   struct cfg80211_connect_params *sme);
4040 	int	(*update_connect_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4041 					 struct net_device *dev,
4042 					 struct cfg80211_connect_params *sme,
4043 					 u32 changed);
4044 	int	(*disconnect)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4045 			      u16 reason_code);
4046 
4047 	int	(*join_ibss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4048 			     struct cfg80211_ibss_params *params);
4049 	int	(*leave_ibss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev);
4050 
4051 	int	(*set_mcast_rate)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4052 				  int rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]);
4053 
4054 	int	(*set_wiphy_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 changed);
4055 
4056 	int	(*set_tx_power)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4057 				enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type, int mbm);
4058 	int	(*get_tx_power)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4059 				int *dbm);
4060 
4061 	int	(*set_wds_peer)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4062 				const u8 *addr);
4063 
4064 	void	(*rfkill_poll)(struct wiphy *wiphy);
4065 
4066 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE
4067 	int	(*testmode_cmd)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4068 				void *data, int len);
4069 	int	(*testmode_dump)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct sk_buff *skb,
4070 				 struct netlink_callback *cb,
4071 				 void *data, int len);
4072 #endif
4073 
4074 	int	(*set_bitrate_mask)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4075 				    struct net_device *dev,
4076 				    const u8 *peer,
4077 				    const struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask *mask);
4078 
4079 	int	(*dump_survey)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4080 			int idx, struct survey_info *info);
4081 
4082 	int	(*set_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4083 			     struct cfg80211_pmksa *pmksa);
4084 	int	(*del_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4085 			     struct cfg80211_pmksa *pmksa);
4086 	int	(*flush_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev);
4087 
4088 	int	(*remain_on_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4089 				     struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4090 				     struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
4091 				     unsigned int duration,
4092 				     u64 *cookie);
4093 	int	(*cancel_remain_on_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4094 					    struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4095 					    u64 cookie);
4096 
4097 	int	(*mgmt_tx)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4098 			   struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params *params,
4099 			   u64 *cookie);
4100 	int	(*mgmt_tx_cancel_wait)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4101 				       struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4102 				       u64 cookie);
4103 
4104 	int	(*set_power_mgmt)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4105 				  bool enabled, int timeout);
4106 
4107 	int	(*set_cqm_rssi_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4108 				       struct net_device *dev,
4109 				       s32 rssi_thold, u32 rssi_hyst);
4110 
4111 	int	(*set_cqm_rssi_range_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4112 					     struct net_device *dev,
4113 					     s32 rssi_low, s32 rssi_high);
4114 
4115 	int	(*set_cqm_txe_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4116 				      struct net_device *dev,
4117 				      u32 rate, u32 pkts, u32 intvl);
4118 
4119 	void	(*update_mgmt_frame_registrations)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4120 						   struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4121 						   struct mgmt_frame_regs *upd);
4122 
4123 	int	(*set_antenna)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 tx_ant, u32 rx_ant);
4124 	int	(*get_antenna)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 *tx_ant, u32 *rx_ant);
4125 
4126 	int	(*sched_scan_start)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4127 				struct net_device *dev,
4128 				struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *request);
4129 	int	(*sched_scan_stop)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4130 				   u64 reqid);
4131 
4132 	int	(*set_rekey_data)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4133 				  struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data *data);
4134 
4135 	int	(*tdls_mgmt)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4136 			     const u8 *peer, u8 action_code,  u8 dialog_token,
4137 			     u16 status_code, u32 peer_capability,
4138 			     bool initiator, const u8 *buf, size_t len);
4139 	int	(*tdls_oper)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4140 			     const u8 *peer, enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper);
4141 
4142 	int	(*probe_client)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4143 				const u8 *peer, u64 *cookie);
4144 
4145 	int	(*set_noack_map)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4146 				  struct net_device *dev,
4147 				  u16 noack_map);
4148 
4149 	int	(*get_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4150 			       struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4151 			       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4152 
4153 	int	(*start_p2p_device)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4154 				    struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4155 	void	(*stop_p2p_device)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4156 				   struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4157 
4158 	int	(*set_mac_acl)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4159 			       const struct cfg80211_acl_data *params);
4160 
4161 	int	(*start_radar_detection)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4162 					 struct net_device *dev,
4163 					 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
4164 					 u32 cac_time_ms);
4165 	void	(*end_cac)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4166 				struct net_device *dev);
4167 	int	(*update_ft_ies)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4168 				 struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params *ftie);
4169 	int	(*crit_proto_start)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4170 				    struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4171 				    enum nl80211_crit_proto_id protocol,
4172 				    u16 duration);
4173 	void	(*crit_proto_stop)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4174 				   struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4175 	int	(*set_coalesce)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4176 				struct cfg80211_coalesce *coalesce);
4177 
4178 	int	(*channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4179 				  struct net_device *dev,
4180 				  struct cfg80211_csa_settings *params);
4181 
4182 	int     (*set_qos_map)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4183 			       struct net_device *dev,
4184 			       struct cfg80211_qos_map *qos_map);
4185 
4186 	int	(*set_ap_chanwidth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4187 				    struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4188 
4189 	int	(*add_tx_ts)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4190 			     u8 tsid, const u8 *peer, u8 user_prio,
4191 			     u16 admitted_time);
4192 	int	(*del_tx_ts)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4193 			     u8 tsid, const u8 *peer);
4194 
4195 	int	(*tdls_channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4196 				       struct net_device *dev,
4197 				       const u8 *addr, u8 oper_class,
4198 				       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4199 	void	(*tdls_cancel_channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4200 					      struct net_device *dev,
4201 					      const u8 *addr);
4202 	int	(*start_nan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4203 			     struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf);
4204 	void	(*stop_nan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4205 	int	(*add_nan_func)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4206 				struct cfg80211_nan_func *nan_func);
4207 	void	(*del_nan_func)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4208 			       u64 cookie);
4209 	int	(*nan_change_conf)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4210 				   struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4211 				   struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf,
4212 				   u32 changes);
4213 
4214 	int	(*set_multicast_to_unicast)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4215 					    struct net_device *dev,
4216 					    const bool enabled);
4217 
4218 	int	(*get_txq_stats)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4219 				 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4220 				 struct cfg80211_txq_stats *txqstats);
4221 
4222 	int	(*set_pmk)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4223 			   const struct cfg80211_pmk_conf *conf);
4224 	int	(*del_pmk)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4225 			   const u8 *aa);
4226 	int     (*external_auth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4227 				 struct cfg80211_external_auth_params *params);
4228 
4229 	int	(*tx_control_port)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4230 				   struct net_device *dev,
4231 				   const u8 *buf, size_t len,
4232 				   const u8 *dest, const __be16 proto,
4233 				   const bool noencrypt,
4234 				   u64 *cookie);
4235 
4236 	int	(*get_ftm_responder_stats)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4237 				struct net_device *dev,
4238 				struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats *ftm_stats);
4239 
4240 	int	(*start_pmsr)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4241 			      struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4242 	void	(*abort_pmsr)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4243 			      struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4244 	int	(*update_owe_info)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4245 				   struct cfg80211_update_owe_info *owe_info);
4246 	int	(*probe_mesh_link)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4247 				   const u8 *buf, size_t len);
4248 	int     (*set_tid_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4249 				  struct cfg80211_tid_config *tid_conf);
4250 	int	(*reset_tid_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4251 				    const u8 *peer, u8 tids);
4252 };
4253 
4254 /*
4255  * wireless hardware and networking interfaces structures
4256  * and registration/helper functions
4257  */
4258 
4259 /**
4260  * enum wiphy_flags - wiphy capability flags
4261  *
4262  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SPLIT_SCAN_6GHZ: if set to true, the scan request will be split
4263  *	 into two, first for legacy bands and second for UHB.
4264  * @WIPHY_FLAG_NETNS_OK: if not set, do not allow changing the netns of this
4265  *	wiphy at all
4266  * @WIPHY_FLAG_PS_ON_BY_DEFAULT: if set to true, powersave will be enabled
4267  *	by default -- this flag will be set depending on the kernel's default
4268  *	on wiphy_new(), but can be changed by the driver if it has a good
4269  *	reason to override the default
4270  * @WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_AP: supports 4addr mode even on AP (with a single station
4271  *	on a VLAN interface). This flag also serves an extra purpose of
4272  *	supporting 4ADDR AP mode on devices which do not support AP/VLAN iftype.
4273  * @WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_STATION: supports 4addr mode even as a station
4274  * @WIPHY_FLAG_CONTROL_PORT_PROTOCOL: This device supports setting the
4275  *	control port protocol ethertype. The device also honours the
4276  *	control_port_no_encrypt flag.
4277  * @WIPHY_FLAG_IBSS_RSN: The device supports IBSS RSN.
4278  * @WIPHY_FLAG_MESH_AUTH: The device supports mesh authentication by routing
4279  *	auth frames to userspace. See @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH.
4280  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_FW_ROAM: The device supports roaming feature in the
4281  *	firmware.
4282  * @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_UAPSD: The device supports uapsd on AP.
4283  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_TDLS: The device supports TDLS (802.11z) operation.
4284  * @WIPHY_FLAG_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP: The device does not handle TDLS (802.11z)
4285  *	link setup/discovery operations internally. Setup, discovery and
4286  *	teardown packets should be sent through the @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT
4287  *	command. When this flag is not set, @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER should be
4288  *	used for asking the driver/firmware to perform a TDLS operation.
4289  * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAVE_AP_SME: device integrates AP SME
4290  * @WIPHY_FLAG_REPORTS_OBSS: the device will report beacons from other BSSes
4291  *	when there are virtual interfaces in AP mode by calling
4292  *	cfg80211_report_obss_beacon().
4293  * @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD: When operating as an AP, the device
4294  *	responds to probe-requests in hardware.
4295  * @WIPHY_FLAG_OFFCHAN_TX: Device supports direct off-channel TX.
4296  * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL: Device supports remain-on-channel call.
4297  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_5_10_MHZ: Device supports 5 MHz and 10 MHz channels.
4298  * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Device supports channel switch in
4299  *	beaconing mode (AP, IBSS, Mesh, ...).
4300  * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_STATIC_WEP: The device supports static WEP key installation
4301  *	before connection.
4302  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KEK_KCK: The device supports bigger kek and kck keys
4303  */
4304 enum wiphy_flags {
4305 	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KEK_KCK		= BIT(0),
4306 	/* use hole at 1 */
4307 	WIPHY_FLAG_SPLIT_SCAN_6GHZ		= BIT(2),
4308 	WIPHY_FLAG_NETNS_OK			= BIT(3),
4309 	WIPHY_FLAG_PS_ON_BY_DEFAULT		= BIT(4),
4310 	WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_AP			= BIT(5),
4311 	WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_STATION		= BIT(6),
4312 	WIPHY_FLAG_CONTROL_PORT_PROTOCOL	= BIT(7),
4313 	WIPHY_FLAG_IBSS_RSN			= BIT(8),
4314 	WIPHY_FLAG_MESH_AUTH			= BIT(10),
4315 	/* use hole at 11 */
4316 	/* use hole at 12 */
4317 	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_FW_ROAM		= BIT(13),
4318 	WIPHY_FLAG_AP_UAPSD			= BIT(14),
4319 	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_TDLS		= BIT(15),
4320 	WIPHY_FLAG_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP		= BIT(16),
4321 	WIPHY_FLAG_HAVE_AP_SME			= BIT(17),
4322 	WIPHY_FLAG_REPORTS_OBSS			= BIT(18),
4323 	WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD	= BIT(19),
4324 	WIPHY_FLAG_OFFCHAN_TX			= BIT(20),
4325 	WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL	= BIT(21),
4326 	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_5_10_MHZ		= BIT(22),
4327 	WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_CHANNEL_SWITCH		= BIT(23),
4328 	WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_STATIC_WEP		= BIT(24),
4329 };
4330 
4331 /**
4332  * struct ieee80211_iface_limit - limit on certain interface types
4333  * @max: maximum number of interfaces of these types
4334  * @types: interface types (bits)
4335  */
4336 struct ieee80211_iface_limit {
4337 	u16 max;
4338 	u16 types;
4339 };
4340 
4341 /**
4342  * struct ieee80211_iface_combination - possible interface combination
4343  *
4344  * With this structure the driver can describe which interface
4345  * combinations it supports concurrently.
4346  *
4347  * Examples:
4348  *
4349  * 1. Allow #STA <= 1, #AP <= 1, matching BI, channels = 1, 2 total:
4350  *
4351  *    .. code-block:: c
4352  *
4353  *	struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits1[] = {
4354  *		{ .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION), },
4355  *		{ .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_AP}, },
4356  *	};
4357  *	struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination1 = {
4358  *		.limits = limits1,
4359  *		.n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits1),
4360  *		.max_interfaces = 2,
4361  *		.beacon_int_infra_match = true,
4362  *	};
4363  *
4364  *
4365  * 2. Allow #{AP, P2P-GO} <= 8, channels = 1, 8 total:
4366  *
4367  *    .. code-block:: c
4368  *
4369  *	struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits2[] = {
4370  *		{ .max = 8, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_AP) |
4371  *				     BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO), },
4372  *	};
4373  *	struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination2 = {
4374  *		.limits = limits2,
4375  *		.n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits2),
4376  *		.max_interfaces = 8,
4377  *		.num_different_channels = 1,
4378  *	};
4379  *
4380  *
4381  * 3. Allow #STA <= 1, #{P2P-client,P2P-GO} <= 3 on two channels, 4 total.
4382  *
4383  *    This allows for an infrastructure connection and three P2P connections.
4384  *
4385  *    .. code-block:: c
4386  *
4387  *	struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits3[] = {
4388  *		{ .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION), },
4389  *		{ .max = 3, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO) |
4390  *				     BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT), },
4391  *	};
4392  *	struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination3 = {
4393  *		.limits = limits3,
4394  *		.n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits3),
4395  *		.max_interfaces = 4,
4396  *		.num_different_channels = 2,
4397  *	};
4398  *
4399  */
4400 struct ieee80211_iface_combination {
4401 	/**
4402 	 * @limits:
4403 	 * limits for the given interface types
4404 	 */
4405 	const struct ieee80211_iface_limit *limits;
4406 
4407 	/**
4408 	 * @num_different_channels:
4409 	 * can use up to this many different channels
4410 	 */
4411 	u32 num_different_channels;
4412 
4413 	/**
4414 	 * @max_interfaces:
4415 	 * maximum number of interfaces in total allowed in this group
4416 	 */
4417 	u16 max_interfaces;
4418 
4419 	/**
4420 	 * @n_limits:
4421 	 * number of limitations
4422 	 */
4423 	u8 n_limits;
4424 
4425 	/**
4426 	 * @beacon_int_infra_match:
4427 	 * In this combination, the beacon intervals between infrastructure
4428 	 * and AP types must match. This is required only in special cases.
4429 	 */
4430 	bool beacon_int_infra_match;
4431 
4432 	/**
4433 	 * @radar_detect_widths:
4434 	 * bitmap of channel widths supported for radar detection
4435 	 */
4436 	u8 radar_detect_widths;
4437 
4438 	/**
4439 	 * @radar_detect_regions:
4440 	 * bitmap of regions supported for radar detection
4441 	 */
4442 	u8 radar_detect_regions;
4443 
4444 	/**
4445 	 * @beacon_int_min_gcd:
4446 	 * This interface combination supports different beacon intervals.
4447 	 *
4448 	 * = 0
4449 	 *   all beacon intervals for different interface must be same.
4450 	 * > 0
4451 	 *   any beacon interval for the interface part of this combination AND
4452 	 *   GCD of all beacon intervals from beaconing interfaces of this
4453 	 *   combination must be greater or equal to this value.
4454 	 */
4455 	u32 beacon_int_min_gcd;
4456 };
4457 
4458 struct ieee80211_txrx_stypes {
4459 	u16 tx, rx;
4460 };
4461 
4462 /**
4463  * enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags - WoWLAN support flags
4464  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_ANY: supports wakeup for the special "any"
4465  *	trigger that keeps the device operating as-is and
4466  *	wakes up the host on any activity, for example a
4467  *	received packet that passed filtering; note that the
4468  *	packet should be preserved in that case
4469  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_MAGIC_PKT: supports wakeup on magic packet
4470  *	(see nl80211.h)
4471  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_DISCONNECT: supports wakeup on disconnect
4472  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_SUPPORTS_GTK_REKEY: supports GTK rekeying while asleep
4473  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE: supports wakeup on GTK rekey failure
4474  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_EAP_IDENTITY_REQ: supports wakeup on EAP identity request
4475  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_4WAY_HANDSHAKE: supports wakeup on 4-way handshake failure
4476  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_RFKILL_RELEASE: supports wakeup on RF-kill release
4477  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_NET_DETECT: supports wakeup on network detection
4478  */
4479 enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags {
4480 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_ANY		= BIT(0),
4481 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_MAGIC_PKT		= BIT(1),
4482 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_DISCONNECT		= BIT(2),
4483 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_SUPPORTS_GTK_REKEY	= BIT(3),
4484 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE	= BIT(4),
4485 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_EAP_IDENTITY_REQ	= BIT(5),
4486 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_4WAY_HANDSHAKE	= BIT(6),
4487 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_RFKILL_RELEASE	= BIT(7),
4488 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_NET_DETECT		= BIT(8),
4489 };
4490 
4491 struct wiphy_wowlan_tcp_support {
4492 	const struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature *tok;
4493 	u32 data_payload_max;
4494 	u32 data_interval_max;
4495 	u32 wake_payload_max;
4496 	bool seq;
4497 };
4498 
4499 /**
4500  * struct wiphy_wowlan_support - WoWLAN support data
4501  * @flags: see &enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags
4502  * @n_patterns: number of supported wakeup patterns
4503  *	(see nl80211.h for the pattern definition)
4504  * @pattern_max_len: maximum length of each pattern
4505  * @pattern_min_len: minimum length of each pattern
4506  * @max_pkt_offset: maximum Rx packet offset
4507  * @max_nd_match_sets: maximum number of matchsets for net-detect,
4508  *	similar, but not necessarily identical, to max_match_sets for
4509  *	scheduled scans.
4510  *	See &struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request.@match_sets for more
4511  *	details.
4512  * @tcp: TCP wakeup support information
4513  */
4514 struct wiphy_wowlan_support {
4515 	u32 flags;
4516 	int n_patterns;
4517 	int pattern_max_len;
4518 	int pattern_min_len;
4519 	int max_pkt_offset;
4520 	int max_nd_match_sets;
4521 	const struct wiphy_wowlan_tcp_support *tcp;
4522 };
4523 
4524 /**
4525  * struct wiphy_coalesce_support - coalesce support data
4526  * @n_rules: maximum number of coalesce rules
4527  * @max_delay: maximum supported coalescing delay in msecs
4528  * @n_patterns: number of supported patterns in a rule
4529  *	(see nl80211.h for the pattern definition)
4530  * @pattern_max_len: maximum length of each pattern
4531  * @pattern_min_len: minimum length of each pattern
4532  * @max_pkt_offset: maximum Rx packet offset
4533  */
4534 struct wiphy_coalesce_support {
4535 	int n_rules;
4536 	int max_delay;
4537 	int n_patterns;
4538 	int pattern_max_len;
4539 	int pattern_min_len;
4540 	int max_pkt_offset;
4541 };
4542 
4543 /**
4544  * enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags - validation flags for vendor commands
4545  * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_WDEV: vendor command requires wdev
4546  * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_NETDEV: vendor command requires netdev
4547  * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_RUNNING: interface/wdev must be up & running
4548  *	(must be combined with %_WDEV or %_NETDEV)
4549  */
4550 enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags {
4551 	WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_WDEV = BIT(0),
4552 	WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_NETDEV = BIT(1),
4553 	WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_RUNNING = BIT(2),
4554 };
4555 
4556 /**
4557  * enum wiphy_opmode_flag - Station's ht/vht operation mode information flags
4558  *
4559  * @STA_OPMODE_MAX_BW_CHANGED: Max Bandwidth changed
4560  * @STA_OPMODE_SMPS_MODE_CHANGED: SMPS mode changed
4561  * @STA_OPMODE_N_SS_CHANGED: max N_SS (number of spatial streams) changed
4562  *
4563  */
4564 enum wiphy_opmode_flag {
4565 	STA_OPMODE_MAX_BW_CHANGED	= BIT(0),
4566 	STA_OPMODE_SMPS_MODE_CHANGED	= BIT(1),
4567 	STA_OPMODE_N_SS_CHANGED		= BIT(2),
4568 };
4569 
4570 /**
4571  * struct sta_opmode_info - Station's ht/vht operation mode information
4572  * @changed: contains value from &enum wiphy_opmode_flag
4573  * @smps_mode: New SMPS mode value from &enum nl80211_smps_mode of a station
4574  * @bw: new max bandwidth value from &enum nl80211_chan_width of a station
4575  * @rx_nss: new rx_nss value of a station
4576  */
4577 
4578 struct sta_opmode_info {
4579 	u32 changed;
4580 	enum nl80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
4581 	enum nl80211_chan_width bw;
4582 	u8 rx_nss;
4583 };
4584 
4585 #define VENDOR_CMD_RAW_DATA ((const struct nla_policy *)(long)(-ENODATA))
4586 
4587 /**
4588  * struct wiphy_vendor_command - vendor command definition
4589  * @info: vendor command identifying information, as used in nl80211
4590  * @flags: flags, see &enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags
4591  * @doit: callback for the operation, note that wdev is %NULL if the
4592  *	flags didn't ask for a wdev and non-%NULL otherwise; the data
4593  *	pointer may be %NULL if userspace provided no data at all
4594  * @dumpit: dump callback, for transferring bigger/multiple items. The
4595  *	@storage points to cb->args[5], ie. is preserved over the multiple
4596  *	dumpit calls.
4597  * @policy: policy pointer for attributes within %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA.
4598  *	Set this to %VENDOR_CMD_RAW_DATA if no policy can be given and the
4599  *	attribute is just raw data (e.g. a firmware command).
4600  * @maxattr: highest attribute number in policy
4601  * It's recommended to not have the same sub command with both @doit and
4602  * @dumpit, so that userspace can assume certain ones are get and others
4603  * are used with dump requests.
4604  */
4605 struct wiphy_vendor_command {
4606 	struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info info;
4607 	u32 flags;
4608 	int (*doit)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4609 		    const void *data, int data_len);
4610 	int (*dumpit)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4611 		      struct sk_buff *skb, const void *data, int data_len,
4612 		      unsigned long *storage);
4613 	const struct nla_policy *policy;
4614 	unsigned int maxattr;
4615 };
4616 
4617 /**
4618  * struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab - extended capabilities per interface type
4619  * @iftype: interface type
4620  * @extended_capabilities: extended capabilities supported by the driver,
4621  *	additional capabilities might be supported by userspace; these are the
4622  *	802.11 extended capabilities ("Extended Capabilities element") and are
4623  *	in the same format as in the information element. See IEEE Std
4624  *	802.11-2012 8.4.2.29 for the defined fields.
4625  * @extended_capabilities_mask: mask of the valid values
4626  * @extended_capabilities_len: length of the extended capabilities
4627  */
4628 struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab {
4629 	enum nl80211_iftype iftype;
4630 	const u8 *extended_capabilities;
4631 	const u8 *extended_capabilities_mask;
4632 	u8 extended_capabilities_len;
4633 };
4634 
4635 /**
4636  * struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities - cfg80211 peer measurement capabilities
4637  * @max_peers: maximum number of peers in a single measurement
4638  * @report_ap_tsf: can report assoc AP's TSF for radio resource measurement
4639  * @randomize_mac_addr: can randomize MAC address for measurement
4640  * @ftm.supported: FTM measurement is supported
4641  * @ftm.asap: ASAP-mode is supported
4642  * @ftm.non_asap: non-ASAP-mode is supported
4643  * @ftm.request_lci: can request LCI data
4644  * @ftm.request_civicloc: can request civic location data
4645  * @ftm.preambles: bitmap of preambles supported (&enum nl80211_preamble)
4646  * @ftm.bandwidths: bitmap of bandwidths supported (&enum nl80211_chan_width)
4647  * @ftm.max_bursts_exponent: maximum burst exponent supported
4648  *	(set to -1 if not limited; note that setting this will necessarily
4649  *	forbid using the value 15 to let the responder pick)
4650  * @ftm.max_ftms_per_burst: maximum FTMs per burst supported (set to 0 if
4651  *	not limited)
4652  * @ftm.trigger_based: trigger based ranging measurement is supported
4653  * @ftm.non_trigger_based: non trigger based ranging measurement is supported
4654  */
4655 struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities {
4656 	unsigned int max_peers;
4657 	u8 report_ap_tsf:1,
4658 	   randomize_mac_addr:1;
4659 
4660 	struct {
4661 		u32 preambles;
4662 		u32 bandwidths;
4663 		s8 max_bursts_exponent;
4664 		u8 max_ftms_per_burst;
4665 		u8 supported:1,
4666 		   asap:1,
4667 		   non_asap:1,
4668 		   request_lci:1,
4669 		   request_civicloc:1,
4670 		   trigger_based:1,
4671 		   non_trigger_based:1;
4672 	} ftm;
4673 };
4674 
4675 /**
4676  * struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites - This structure encapsulates supported akm
4677  * suites for interface types defined in @iftypes_mask. Each type in the
4678  * @iftypes_mask must be unique across all instances of iftype_akm_suites.
4679  *
4680  * @iftypes_mask: bitmask of interfaces types
4681  * @akm_suites: points to an array of supported akm suites
4682  * @n_akm_suites: number of supported AKM suites
4683  */
4684 struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites {
4685 	u16 iftypes_mask;
4686 	const u32 *akm_suites;
4687 	int n_akm_suites;
4688 };
4689 
4690 /**
4691  * struct wiphy - wireless hardware description
4692  * @reg_notifier: the driver's regulatory notification callback,
4693  *	note that if your driver uses wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory()
4694  *	the reg_notifier's request can be passed as NULL
4695  * @regd: the driver's regulatory domain, if one was requested via
4696  *	the regulatory_hint() API. This can be used by the driver
4697  *	on the reg_notifier() if it chooses to ignore future
4698  *	regulatory domain changes caused by other drivers.
4699  * @signal_type: signal type reported in &struct cfg80211_bss.
4700  * @cipher_suites: supported cipher suites
4701  * @n_cipher_suites: number of supported cipher suites
4702  * @akm_suites: supported AKM suites. These are the default AKMs supported if
4703  *	the supported AKMs not advertized for a specific interface type in
4704  *	iftype_akm_suites.
4705  * @n_akm_suites: number of supported AKM suites
4706  * @iftype_akm_suites: array of supported akm suites info per interface type.
4707  *	Note that the bits in @iftypes_mask inside this structure cannot
4708  *	overlap (i.e. only one occurrence of each type is allowed across all
4709  *	instances of iftype_akm_suites).
4710  * @num_iftype_akm_suites: number of interface types for which supported akm
4711  *	suites are specified separately.
4712  * @retry_short: Retry limit for short frames (dot11ShortRetryLimit)
4713  * @retry_long: Retry limit for long frames (dot11LongRetryLimit)
4714  * @frag_threshold: Fragmentation threshold (dot11FragmentationThreshold);
4715  *	-1 = fragmentation disabled, only odd values >= 256 used
4716  * @rts_threshold: RTS threshold (dot11RTSThreshold); -1 = RTS/CTS disabled
4717  * @_net: the network namespace this wiphy currently lives in
4718  * @perm_addr: permanent MAC address of this device
4719  * @addr_mask: If the device supports multiple MAC addresses by masking,
4720  *	set this to a mask with variable bits set to 1, e.g. if the last
4721  *	four bits are variable then set it to 00-00-00-00-00-0f. The actual
4722  *	variable bits shall be determined by the interfaces added, with
4723  *	interfaces not matching the mask being rejected to be brought up.
4724  * @n_addresses: number of addresses in @addresses.
4725  * @addresses: If the device has more than one address, set this pointer
4726  *	to a list of addresses (6 bytes each). The first one will be used
4727  *	by default for perm_addr. In this case, the mask should be set to
4728  *	all-zeroes. In this case it is assumed that the device can handle
4729  *	the same number of arbitrary MAC addresses.
4730  * @registered: protects ->resume and ->suspend sysfs callbacks against
4731  *	unregister hardware
4732  * @debugfsdir: debugfs directory used for this wiphy (ieee80211/<wiphyname>).
4733  *	It will be renamed automatically on wiphy renames
4734  * @dev: (virtual) struct device for this wiphy. The item in
4735  *	/sys/class/ieee80211/ points to this. You need use set_wiphy_dev()
4736  *	(see below).
4737  * @wext: wireless extension handlers
4738  * @priv: driver private data (sized according to wiphy_new() parameter)
4739  * @interface_modes: bitmask of interfaces types valid for this wiphy,
4740  *	must be set by driver
4741  * @iface_combinations: Valid interface combinations array, should not
4742  *	list single interface types.
4743  * @n_iface_combinations: number of entries in @iface_combinations array.
4744  * @software_iftypes: bitmask of software interface types, these are not
4745  *	subject to any restrictions since they are purely managed in SW.
4746  * @flags: wiphy flags, see &enum wiphy_flags
4747  * @regulatory_flags: wiphy regulatory flags, see
4748  *	&enum ieee80211_regulatory_flags
4749  * @features: features advertised to nl80211, see &enum nl80211_feature_flags.
4750  * @ext_features: extended features advertised to nl80211, see
4751  *	&enum nl80211_ext_feature_index.
4752  * @bss_priv_size: each BSS struct has private data allocated with it,
4753  *	this variable determines its size
4754  * @max_scan_ssids: maximum number of SSIDs the device can scan for in
4755  *	any given scan
4756  * @max_sched_scan_reqs: maximum number of scheduled scan requests that
4757  *	the device can run concurrently.
4758  * @max_sched_scan_ssids: maximum number of SSIDs the device can scan
4759  *	for in any given scheduled scan
4760  * @max_match_sets: maximum number of match sets the device can handle
4761  *	when performing a scheduled scan, 0 if filtering is not
4762  *	supported.
4763  * @max_scan_ie_len: maximum length of user-controlled IEs device can
4764  *	add to probe request frames transmitted during a scan, must not
4765  *	include fixed IEs like supported rates
4766  * @max_sched_scan_ie_len: same as max_scan_ie_len, but for scheduled
4767  *	scans
4768  * @max_sched_scan_plans: maximum number of scan plans (scan interval and number
4769  *	of iterations) for scheduled scan supported by the device.
4770  * @max_sched_scan_plan_interval: maximum interval (in seconds) for a
4771  *	single scan plan supported by the device.
4772  * @max_sched_scan_plan_iterations: maximum number of iterations for a single
4773  *	scan plan supported by the device.
4774  * @coverage_class: current coverage class
4775  * @fw_version: firmware version for ethtool reporting
4776  * @hw_version: hardware version for ethtool reporting
4777  * @max_num_pmkids: maximum number of PMKIDs supported by device
4778  * @privid: a pointer that drivers can use to identify if an arbitrary
4779  *	wiphy is theirs, e.g. in global notifiers
4780  * @bands: information about bands/channels supported by this device
4781  *
4782  * @mgmt_stypes: bitmasks of frame subtypes that can be subscribed to or
4783  *	transmitted through nl80211, points to an array indexed by interface
4784  *	type
4785  *
4786  * @available_antennas_tx: bitmap of antennas which are available to be
4787  *	configured as TX antennas. Antenna configuration commands will be
4788  *	rejected unless this or @available_antennas_rx is set.
4789  *
4790  * @available_antennas_rx: bitmap of antennas which are available to be
4791  *	configured as RX antennas. Antenna configuration commands will be
4792  *	rejected unless this or @available_antennas_tx is set.
4793  *
4794  * @probe_resp_offload:
4795  *	 Bitmap of supported protocols for probe response offloading.
4796  *	 See &enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr. Only valid
4797  *	 when the wiphy flag @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD is set.
4798  *
4799  * @max_remain_on_channel_duration: Maximum time a remain-on-channel operation
4800  *	may request, if implemented.
4801  *
4802  * @wowlan: WoWLAN support information
4803  * @wowlan_config: current WoWLAN configuration; this should usually not be
4804  *	used since access to it is necessarily racy, use the parameter passed
4805  *	to the suspend() operation instead.
4806  *
4807  * @ap_sme_capa: AP SME capabilities, flags from &enum nl80211_ap_sme_features.
4808  * @ht_capa_mod_mask:  Specify what ht_cap values can be over-ridden.
4809  *	If null, then none can be over-ridden.
4810  * @vht_capa_mod_mask:  Specify what VHT capabilities can be over-ridden.
4811  *	If null, then none can be over-ridden.
4812  *
4813  * @wdev_list: the list of associated (virtual) interfaces; this list must
4814  *	not be modified by the driver, but can be read with RTNL/RCU protection.
4815  *
4816  * @max_acl_mac_addrs: Maximum number of MAC addresses that the device
4817  *	supports for ACL.
4818  *
4819  * @extended_capabilities: extended capabilities supported by the driver,
4820  *	additional capabilities might be supported by userspace; these are
4821  *	the 802.11 extended capabilities ("Extended Capabilities element")
4822  *	and are in the same format as in the information element. See
4823  *	802.11-2012 8.4.2.29 for the defined fields. These are the default
4824  *	extended capabilities to be used if the capabilities are not specified
4825  *	for a specific interface type in iftype_ext_capab.
4826  * @extended_capabilities_mask: mask of the valid values
4827  * @extended_capabilities_len: length of the extended capabilities
4828  * @iftype_ext_capab: array of extended capabilities per interface type
4829  * @num_iftype_ext_capab: number of interface types for which extended
4830  *	capabilities are specified separately.
4831  * @coalesce: packet coalescing support information
4832  *
4833  * @vendor_commands: array of vendor commands supported by the hardware
4834  * @n_vendor_commands: number of vendor commands
4835  * @vendor_events: array of vendor events supported by the hardware
4836  * @n_vendor_events: number of vendor events
4837  *
4838  * @max_ap_assoc_sta: maximum number of associated stations supported in AP mode
4839  *	(including P2P GO) or 0 to indicate no such limit is advertised. The
4840  *	driver is allowed to advertise a theoretical limit that it can reach in
4841  *	some cases, but may not always reach.
4842  *
4843  * @max_num_csa_counters: Number of supported csa_counters in beacons
4844  *	and probe responses.  This value should be set if the driver
4845  *	wishes to limit the number of csa counters. Default (0) means
4846  *	infinite.
4847  * @bss_select_support: bitmask indicating the BSS selection criteria supported
4848  *	by the driver in the .connect() callback. The bit position maps to the
4849  *	attribute indices defined in &enum nl80211_bss_select_attr.
4850  *
4851  * @nan_supported_bands: bands supported by the device in NAN mode, a
4852  *	bitmap of &enum nl80211_band values.  For instance, for
4853  *	NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, bit 0 would be set
4854  *	(i.e. BIT(NL80211_BAND_2GHZ)).
4855  *
4856  * @txq_limit: configuration of internal TX queue frame limit
4857  * @txq_memory_limit: configuration internal TX queue memory limit
4858  * @txq_quantum: configuration of internal TX queue scheduler quantum
4859  *
4860  * @tx_queue_len: allow setting transmit queue len for drivers not using
4861  *	wake_tx_queue
4862  *
4863  * @support_mbssid: can HW support association with nontransmitted AP
4864  * @support_only_he_mbssid: don't parse MBSSID elements if it is not
4865  *	HE AP, in order to avoid compatibility issues.
4866  *	@support_mbssid must be set for this to have any effect.
4867  *
4868  * @pmsr_capa: peer measurement capabilities
4869  *
4870  * @tid_config_support: describes the per-TID config support that the
4871  *	device has
4872  * @tid_config_support.vif: bitmap of attributes (configurations)
4873  *	supported by the driver for each vif
4874  * @tid_config_support.peer: bitmap of attributes (configurations)
4875  *	supported by the driver for each peer
4876  * @tid_config_support.max_retry: maximum supported retry count for
4877  *	long/short retry configuration
4878  *
4879  * @max_data_retry_count: maximum supported per TID retry count for
4880  *	configuration through the %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_SHORT and
4881  *	%NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_LONG attributes
4882  */
4883 struct wiphy {
4884 	/* assign these fields before you register the wiphy */
4885 
4886 	u8 perm_addr[ETH_ALEN];
4887 	u8 addr_mask[ETH_ALEN];
4888 
4889 	struct mac_address *addresses;
4890 
4891 	const struct ieee80211_txrx_stypes *mgmt_stypes;
4892 
4893 	const struct ieee80211_iface_combination *iface_combinations;
4894 	int n_iface_combinations;
4895 	u16 software_iftypes;
4896 
4897 	u16 n_addresses;
4898 
4899 	/* Supported interface modes, OR together BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_...) */
4900 	u16 interface_modes;
4901 
4902 	u16 max_acl_mac_addrs;
4903 
4904 	u32 flags, regulatory_flags, features;
4905 	u8 ext_features[DIV_ROUND_UP(NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES, 8)];
4906 
4907 	u32 ap_sme_capa;
4908 
4909 	enum cfg80211_signal_type signal_type;
4910 
4911 	int bss_priv_size;
4912 	u8 max_scan_ssids;
4913 	u8 max_sched_scan_reqs;
4914 	u8 max_sched_scan_ssids;
4915 	u8 max_match_sets;
4916 	u16 max_scan_ie_len;
4917 	u16 max_sched_scan_ie_len;
4918 	u32 max_sched_scan_plans;
4919 	u32 max_sched_scan_plan_interval;
4920 	u32 max_sched_scan_plan_iterations;
4921 
4922 	int n_cipher_suites;
4923 	const u32 *cipher_suites;
4924 
4925 	int n_akm_suites;
4926 	const u32 *akm_suites;
4927 
4928 	const struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites *iftype_akm_suites;
4929 	unsigned int num_iftype_akm_suites;
4930 
4931 	u8 retry_short;
4932 	u8 retry_long;
4933 	u32 frag_threshold;
4934 	u32 rts_threshold;
4935 	u8 coverage_class;
4936 
4937 	char fw_version[ETHTOOL_FWVERS_LEN];
4938 	u32 hw_version;
4939 
4940 #ifdef CONFIG_PM
4941 	const struct wiphy_wowlan_support *wowlan;
4942 	struct cfg80211_wowlan *wowlan_config;
4943 #endif
4944 
4945 	u16 max_remain_on_channel_duration;
4946 
4947 	u8 max_num_pmkids;
4948 
4949 	u32 available_antennas_tx;
4950 	u32 available_antennas_rx;
4951 
4952 	u32 probe_resp_offload;
4953 
4954 	const u8 *extended_capabilities, *extended_capabilities_mask;
4955 	u8 extended_capabilities_len;
4956 
4957 	const struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab *iftype_ext_capab;
4958 	unsigned int num_iftype_ext_capab;
4959 
4960 	const void *privid;
4961 
4962 	struct ieee80211_supported_band *bands[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
4963 
4964 	void (*reg_notifier)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4965 			     struct regulatory_request *request);
4966 
4967 	/* fields below are read-only, assigned by cfg80211 */
4968 
4969 	const struct ieee80211_regdomain __rcu *regd;
4970 
4971 	struct device dev;
4972 
4973 	bool registered;
4974 
4975 	struct dentry *debugfsdir;
4976 
4977 	const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_capa_mod_mask;
4978 	const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_capa_mod_mask;
4979 
4980 	struct list_head wdev_list;
4981 
4982 	possible_net_t _net;
4983 
4984 #ifdef CONFIG_CFG80211_WEXT
4985 	const struct iw_handler_def *wext;
4986 #endif
4987 
4988 	const struct wiphy_coalesce_support *coalesce;
4989 
4990 	const struct wiphy_vendor_command *vendor_commands;
4991 	const struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info *vendor_events;
4992 	int n_vendor_commands, n_vendor_events;
4993 
4994 	u16 max_ap_assoc_sta;
4995 
4996 	u8 max_num_csa_counters;
4997 
4998 	u32 bss_select_support;
4999 
5000 	u8 nan_supported_bands;
5001 
5002 	u32 txq_limit;
5003 	u32 txq_memory_limit;
5004 	u32 txq_quantum;
5005 
5006 	unsigned long tx_queue_len;
5007 
5008 	u8 support_mbssid:1,
5009 	   support_only_he_mbssid:1;
5010 
5011 	const struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities *pmsr_capa;
5012 
5013 	struct {
5014 		u64 peer, vif;
5015 		u8 max_retry;
5016 	} tid_config_support;
5017 
5018 	u8 max_data_retry_count;
5019 
5020 	char priv[] __aligned(NETDEV_ALIGN);
5021 };
5022 
wiphy_net(struct wiphy * wiphy)5023 static inline struct net *wiphy_net(struct wiphy *wiphy)
5024 {
5025 	return read_pnet(&wiphy->_net);
5026 }
5027 
wiphy_net_set(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct net * net)5028 static inline void wiphy_net_set(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net *net)
5029 {
5030 	write_pnet(&wiphy->_net, net);
5031 }
5032 
5033 /**
5034  * wiphy_priv - return priv from wiphy
5035  *
5036  * @wiphy: the wiphy whose priv pointer to return
5037  * Return: The priv of @wiphy.
5038  */
wiphy_priv(struct wiphy * wiphy)5039 static inline void *wiphy_priv(struct wiphy *wiphy)
5040 {
5041 	BUG_ON(!wiphy);
5042 	return &wiphy->priv;
5043 }
5044 
5045 /**
5046  * priv_to_wiphy - return the wiphy containing the priv
5047  *
5048  * @priv: a pointer previously returned by wiphy_priv
5049  * Return: The wiphy of @priv.
5050  */
priv_to_wiphy(void * priv)5051 static inline struct wiphy *priv_to_wiphy(void *priv)
5052 {
5053 	BUG_ON(!priv);
5054 	return container_of(priv, struct wiphy, priv);
5055 }
5056 
5057 /**
5058  * set_wiphy_dev - set device pointer for wiphy
5059  *
5060  * @wiphy: The wiphy whose device to bind
5061  * @dev: The device to parent it to
5062  */
set_wiphy_dev(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct device * dev)5063 static inline void set_wiphy_dev(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct device *dev)
5064 {
5065 	wiphy->dev.parent = dev;
5066 }
5067 
5068 /**
5069  * wiphy_dev - get wiphy dev pointer
5070  *
5071  * @wiphy: The wiphy whose device struct to look up
5072  * Return: The dev of @wiphy.
5073  */
wiphy_dev(struct wiphy * wiphy)5074 static inline struct device *wiphy_dev(struct wiphy *wiphy)
5075 {
5076 	return wiphy->dev.parent;
5077 }
5078 
5079 /**
5080  * wiphy_name - get wiphy name
5081  *
5082  * @wiphy: The wiphy whose name to return
5083  * Return: The name of @wiphy.
5084  */
wiphy_name(const struct wiphy * wiphy)5085 static inline const char *wiphy_name(const struct wiphy *wiphy)
5086 {
5087 	return dev_name(&wiphy->dev);
5088 }
5089 
5090 /**
5091  * wiphy_new_nm - create a new wiphy for use with cfg80211
5092  *
5093  * @ops: The configuration operations for this device
5094  * @sizeof_priv: The size of the private area to allocate
5095  * @requested_name: Request a particular name.
5096  *	NULL is valid value, and means use the default phy%d naming.
5097  *
5098  * Create a new wiphy and associate the given operations with it.
5099  * @sizeof_priv bytes are allocated for private use.
5100  *
5101  * Return: A pointer to the new wiphy. This pointer must be
5102  * assigned to each netdev's ieee80211_ptr for proper operation.
5103  */
5104 struct wiphy *wiphy_new_nm(const struct cfg80211_ops *ops, int sizeof_priv,
5105 			   const char *requested_name);
5106 
5107 /**
5108  * wiphy_new - create a new wiphy for use with cfg80211
5109  *
5110  * @ops: The configuration operations for this device
5111  * @sizeof_priv: The size of the private area to allocate
5112  *
5113  * Create a new wiphy and associate the given operations with it.
5114  * @sizeof_priv bytes are allocated for private use.
5115  *
5116  * Return: A pointer to the new wiphy. This pointer must be
5117  * assigned to each netdev's ieee80211_ptr for proper operation.
5118  */
wiphy_new(const struct cfg80211_ops * ops,int sizeof_priv)5119 static inline struct wiphy *wiphy_new(const struct cfg80211_ops *ops,
5120 				      int sizeof_priv)
5121 {
5122 	return wiphy_new_nm(ops, sizeof_priv, NULL);
5123 }
5124 
5125 /**
5126  * wiphy_register - register a wiphy with cfg80211
5127  *
5128  * @wiphy: The wiphy to register.
5129  *
5130  * Return: A non-negative wiphy index or a negative error code.
5131  */
5132 int wiphy_register(struct wiphy *wiphy);
5133 
5134 /**
5135  * wiphy_unregister - deregister a wiphy from cfg80211
5136  *
5137  * @wiphy: The wiphy to unregister.
5138  *
5139  * After this call, no more requests can be made with this priv
5140  * pointer, but the call may sleep to wait for an outstanding
5141  * request that is being handled.
5142  */
5143 void wiphy_unregister(struct wiphy *wiphy);
5144 
5145 /**
5146  * wiphy_free - free wiphy
5147  *
5148  * @wiphy: The wiphy to free
5149  */
5150 void wiphy_free(struct wiphy *wiphy);
5151 
5152 /* internal structs */
5153 struct cfg80211_conn;
5154 struct cfg80211_internal_bss;
5155 struct cfg80211_cached_keys;
5156 struct cfg80211_cqm_config;
5157 
5158 /**
5159  * struct wireless_dev - wireless device state
5160  *
5161  * For netdevs, this structure must be allocated by the driver
5162  * that uses the ieee80211_ptr field in struct net_device (this
5163  * is intentional so it can be allocated along with the netdev.)
5164  * It need not be registered then as netdev registration will
5165  * be intercepted by cfg80211 to see the new wireless device.
5166  *
5167  * For non-netdev uses, it must also be allocated by the driver
5168  * in response to the cfg80211 callbacks that require it, as
5169  * there's no netdev registration in that case it may not be
5170  * allocated outside of callback operations that return it.
5171  *
5172  * @wiphy: pointer to hardware description
5173  * @iftype: interface type
5174  * @list: (private) Used to collect the interfaces
5175  * @netdev: (private) Used to reference back to the netdev, may be %NULL
5176  * @identifier: (private) Identifier used in nl80211 to identify this
5177  *	wireless device if it has no netdev
5178  * @current_bss: (private) Used by the internal configuration code
5179  * @chandef: (private) Used by the internal configuration code to track
5180  *	the user-set channel definition.
5181  * @preset_chandef: (private) Used by the internal configuration code to
5182  *	track the channel to be used for AP later
5183  * @bssid: (private) Used by the internal configuration code
5184  * @ssid: (private) Used by the internal configuration code
5185  * @ssid_len: (private) Used by the internal configuration code
5186  * @mesh_id_len: (private) Used by the internal configuration code
5187  * @mesh_id_up_len: (private) Used by the internal configuration code
5188  * @wext: (private) Used by the internal wireless extensions compat code
5189  * @wext.ibss: (private) IBSS data part of wext handling
5190  * @wext.connect: (private) connection handling data
5191  * @wext.keys: (private) (WEP) key data
5192  * @wext.ie: (private) extra elements for association
5193  * @wext.ie_len: (private) length of extra elements
5194  * @wext.bssid: (private) selected network BSSID
5195  * @wext.ssid: (private) selected network SSID
5196  * @wext.default_key: (private) selected default key index
5197  * @wext.default_mgmt_key: (private) selected default management key index
5198  * @wext.prev_bssid: (private) previous BSSID for reassociation
5199  * @wext.prev_bssid_valid: (private) previous BSSID validity
5200  * @use_4addr: indicates 4addr mode is used on this interface, must be
5201  *	set by driver (if supported) on add_interface BEFORE registering the
5202  *	netdev and may otherwise be used by driver read-only, will be update
5203  *	by cfg80211 on change_interface
5204  * @mgmt_registrations: list of registrations for management frames
5205  * @mgmt_registrations_need_update: mgmt registrations were updated,
5206  *	need to propagate the update to the driver
5207  * @mtx: mutex used to lock data in this struct, may be used by drivers
5208  *	and some API functions require it held
5209  * @beacon_interval: beacon interval used on this device for transmitting
5210  *	beacons, 0 when not valid
5211  * @address: The address for this device, valid only if @netdev is %NULL
5212  * @is_running: true if this is a non-netdev device that has been started, e.g.
5213  *	the P2P Device.
5214  * @cac_started: true if DFS channel availability check has been started
5215  * @cac_start_time: timestamp (jiffies) when the dfs state was entered.
5216  * @cac_time_ms: CAC time in ms
5217  * @ps: powersave mode is enabled
5218  * @ps_timeout: dynamic powersave timeout
5219  * @ap_unexpected_nlportid: (private) netlink port ID of application
5220  *	registered for unexpected class 3 frames (AP mode)
5221  * @conn: (private) cfg80211 software SME connection state machine data
5222  * @connect_keys: (private) keys to set after connection is established
5223  * @conn_bss_type: connecting/connected BSS type
5224  * @conn_owner_nlportid: (private) connection owner socket port ID
5225  * @disconnect_wk: (private) auto-disconnect work
5226  * @disconnect_bssid: (private) the BSSID to use for auto-disconnect
5227  * @ibss_fixed: (private) IBSS is using fixed BSSID
5228  * @ibss_dfs_possible: (private) IBSS may change to a DFS channel
5229  * @event_list: (private) list for internal event processing
5230  * @event_lock: (private) lock for event list
5231  * @owner_nlportid: (private) owner socket port ID
5232  * @nl_owner_dead: (private) owner socket went away
5233  * @cqm_config: (private) nl80211 RSSI monitor state
5234  * @pmsr_list: (private) peer measurement requests
5235  * @pmsr_lock: (private) peer measurements requests/results lock
5236  * @pmsr_free_wk: (private) peer measurements cleanup work
5237  * @unprot_beacon_reported: (private) timestamp of last
5238  *	unprotected beacon report
5239  */
5240 struct wireless_dev {
5241 	struct wiphy *wiphy;
5242 	enum nl80211_iftype iftype;
5243 
5244 	/* the remainder of this struct should be private to cfg80211 */
5245 	struct list_head list;
5246 	struct net_device *netdev;
5247 
5248 	u32 identifier;
5249 
5250 	struct list_head mgmt_registrations;
5251 	u8 mgmt_registrations_need_update:1;
5252 
5253 	struct mutex mtx;
5254 
5255 	bool use_4addr, is_running;
5256 
5257 	u8 address[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(sizeof(u16));
5258 
5259 	/* currently used for IBSS and SME - might be rearranged later */
5260 	u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
5261 	u8 ssid_len, mesh_id_len, mesh_id_up_len;
5262 	struct cfg80211_conn *conn;
5263 	struct cfg80211_cached_keys *connect_keys;
5264 	enum ieee80211_bss_type conn_bss_type;
5265 	u32 conn_owner_nlportid;
5266 
5267 	struct work_struct disconnect_wk;
5268 	u8 disconnect_bssid[ETH_ALEN];
5269 
5270 	struct list_head event_list;
5271 	spinlock_t event_lock;
5272 
5273 	struct cfg80211_internal_bss *current_bss; /* associated / joined */
5274 	struct cfg80211_chan_def preset_chandef;
5275 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
5276 
5277 	bool ibss_fixed;
5278 	bool ibss_dfs_possible;
5279 
5280 	bool ps;
5281 	int ps_timeout;
5282 
5283 	int beacon_interval;
5284 
5285 	u32 ap_unexpected_nlportid;
5286 
5287 	u32 owner_nlportid;
5288 	bool nl_owner_dead;
5289 
5290 	bool cac_started;
5291 	unsigned long cac_start_time;
5292 	unsigned int cac_time_ms;
5293 
5294 #ifdef CONFIG_CFG80211_WEXT
5295 	/* wext data */
5296 	struct {
5297 		struct cfg80211_ibss_params ibss;
5298 		struct cfg80211_connect_params connect;
5299 		struct cfg80211_cached_keys *keys;
5300 		const u8 *ie;
5301 		size_t ie_len;
5302 		u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN];
5303 		u8 prev_bssid[ETH_ALEN];
5304 		u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
5305 		s8 default_key, default_mgmt_key;
5306 		bool prev_bssid_valid;
5307 	} wext;
5308 #endif
5309 
5310 	struct cfg80211_cqm_config *cqm_config;
5311 
5312 	struct list_head pmsr_list;
5313 	spinlock_t pmsr_lock;
5314 	struct work_struct pmsr_free_wk;
5315 
5316 	unsigned long unprot_beacon_reported;
5317 };
5318 
wdev_address(struct wireless_dev * wdev)5319 static inline u8 *wdev_address(struct wireless_dev *wdev)
5320 {
5321 	if (wdev->netdev)
5322 		return wdev->netdev->dev_addr;
5323 	return wdev->address;
5324 }
5325 
wdev_running(struct wireless_dev * wdev)5326 static inline bool wdev_running(struct wireless_dev *wdev)
5327 {
5328 	if (wdev->netdev)
5329 		return netif_running(wdev->netdev);
5330 	return wdev->is_running;
5331 }
5332 
5333 /**
5334  * wdev_priv - return wiphy priv from wireless_dev
5335  *
5336  * @wdev: The wireless device whose wiphy's priv pointer to return
5337  * Return: The wiphy priv of @wdev.
5338  */
wdev_priv(struct wireless_dev * wdev)5339 static inline void *wdev_priv(struct wireless_dev *wdev)
5340 {
5341 	BUG_ON(!wdev);
5342 	return wiphy_priv(wdev->wiphy);
5343 }
5344 
5345 /**
5346  * DOC: Utility functions
5347  *
5348  * cfg80211 offers a number of utility functions that can be useful.
5349  */
5350 
5351 /**
5352  * ieee80211_channel_equal - compare two struct ieee80211_channel
5353  *
5354  * @a: 1st struct ieee80211_channel
5355  * @b: 2nd struct ieee80211_channel
5356  * Return: true if center frequency of @a == @b
5357  */
5358 static inline bool
ieee80211_channel_equal(struct ieee80211_channel * a,struct ieee80211_channel * b)5359 ieee80211_channel_equal(struct ieee80211_channel *a,
5360 			struct ieee80211_channel *b)
5361 {
5362 	return (a->center_freq == b->center_freq &&
5363 		a->freq_offset == b->freq_offset);
5364 }
5365 
5366 /**
5367  * ieee80211_channel_to_khz - convert ieee80211_channel to frequency in KHz
5368  * @chan: struct ieee80211_channel to convert
5369  * Return: The corresponding frequency (in KHz)
5370  */
5371 static inline u32
ieee80211_channel_to_khz(const struct ieee80211_channel * chan)5372 ieee80211_channel_to_khz(const struct ieee80211_channel *chan)
5373 {
5374 	return MHZ_TO_KHZ(chan->center_freq) + chan->freq_offset;
5375 }
5376 
5377 /**
5378  * ieee80211_s1g_channel_width - get allowed channel width from @chan
5379  *
5380  * Only allowed for band NL80211_BAND_S1GHZ
5381  * @chan: channel
5382  * Return: The allowed channel width for this center_freq
5383  */
5384 enum nl80211_chan_width
5385 ieee80211_s1g_channel_width(const struct ieee80211_channel *chan);
5386 
5387 /**
5388  * ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz - convert channel number to frequency
5389  * @chan: channel number
5390  * @band: band, necessary due to channel number overlap
5391  * Return: The corresponding frequency (in KHz), or 0 if the conversion failed.
5392  */
5393 u32 ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz(int chan, enum nl80211_band band);
5394 
5395 /**
5396  * ieee80211_channel_to_frequency - convert channel number to frequency
5397  * @chan: channel number
5398  * @band: band, necessary due to channel number overlap
5399  * Return: The corresponding frequency (in MHz), or 0 if the conversion failed.
5400  */
5401 static inline int
ieee80211_channel_to_frequency(int chan,enum nl80211_band band)5402 ieee80211_channel_to_frequency(int chan, enum nl80211_band band)
5403 {
5404 	return KHZ_TO_MHZ(ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz(chan, band));
5405 }
5406 
5407 /**
5408  * ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel - convert frequency to channel number
5409  * @freq: center frequency in KHz
5410  * Return: The corresponding channel, or 0 if the conversion failed.
5411  */
5412 int ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel(u32 freq);
5413 
5414 /**
5415  * ieee80211_frequency_to_channel - convert frequency to channel number
5416  * @freq: center frequency in MHz
5417  * Return: The corresponding channel, or 0 if the conversion failed.
5418  */
5419 static inline int
ieee80211_frequency_to_channel(int freq)5420 ieee80211_frequency_to_channel(int freq)
5421 {
5422 	return ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel(MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq));
5423 }
5424 
5425 /**
5426  * ieee80211_get_channel_khz - get channel struct from wiphy for specified
5427  * frequency
5428  * @wiphy: the struct wiphy to get the channel for
5429  * @freq: the center frequency (in KHz) of the channel
5430  * Return: The channel struct from @wiphy at @freq.
5431  */
5432 struct ieee80211_channel *
5433 ieee80211_get_channel_khz(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 freq);
5434 
5435 /**
5436  * ieee80211_get_channel - get channel struct from wiphy for specified frequency
5437  *
5438  * @wiphy: the struct wiphy to get the channel for
5439  * @freq: the center frequency (in MHz) of the channel
5440  * Return: The channel struct from @wiphy at @freq.
5441  */
5442 static inline struct ieee80211_channel *
ieee80211_get_channel(struct wiphy * wiphy,int freq)5443 ieee80211_get_channel(struct wiphy *wiphy, int freq)
5444 {
5445 	return ieee80211_get_channel_khz(wiphy, MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq));
5446 }
5447 
5448 /**
5449  * cfg80211_channel_is_psc - Check if the channel is a 6 GHz PSC
5450  * @chan: control channel to check
5451  *
5452  * The Preferred Scanning Channels (PSC) are defined in
5453  * Draft IEEE P802.11ax/D5.0, 26.17.2.3.3
5454  */
cfg80211_channel_is_psc(struct ieee80211_channel * chan)5455 static inline bool cfg80211_channel_is_psc(struct ieee80211_channel *chan)
5456 {
5457 	if (chan->band != NL80211_BAND_6GHZ)
5458 		return false;
5459 
5460 	return ieee80211_frequency_to_channel(chan->center_freq) % 16 == 5;
5461 }
5462 
5463 /**
5464  * ieee80211_get_response_rate - get basic rate for a given rate
5465  *
5466  * @sband: the band to look for rates in
5467  * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates
5468  * @bitrate: the bitrate for which to find the basic rate
5469  *
5470  * Return: The basic rate corresponding to a given bitrate, that
5471  * is the next lower bitrate contained in the basic rate map,
5472  * which is, for this function, given as a bitmap of indices of
5473  * rates in the band's bitrate table.
5474  */
5475 struct ieee80211_rate *
5476 ieee80211_get_response_rate(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
5477 			    u32 basic_rates, int bitrate);
5478 
5479 /**
5480  * ieee80211_mandatory_rates - get mandatory rates for a given band
5481  * @sband: the band to look for rates in
5482  * @scan_width: width of the control channel
5483  *
5484  * This function returns a bitmap of the mandatory rates for the given
5485  * band, bits are set according to the rate position in the bitrates array.
5486  */
5487 u32 ieee80211_mandatory_rates(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
5488 			      enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width);
5489 
5490 /*
5491  * Radiotap parsing functions -- for controlled injection support
5492  *
5493  * Implemented in net/wireless/radiotap.c
5494  * Documentation in Documentation/networking/radiotap-headers.rst
5495  */
5496 
5497 struct radiotap_align_size {
5498 	uint8_t align:4, size:4;
5499 };
5500 
5501 struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace {
5502 	const struct radiotap_align_size *align_size;
5503 	int n_bits;
5504 	uint32_t oui;
5505 	uint8_t subns;
5506 };
5507 
5508 struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces {
5509 	const struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace *ns;
5510 	int n_ns;
5511 };
5512 
5513 /**
5514  * struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator - tracks walk thru present radiotap args
5515  * @this_arg_index: index of current arg, valid after each successful call
5516  *	to ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next()
5517  * @this_arg: pointer to current radiotap arg; it is valid after each
5518  *	call to ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next() but also after
5519  *	ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_init() where it will point to
5520  *	the beginning of the actual data portion
5521  * @this_arg_size: length of the current arg, for convenience
5522  * @current_namespace: pointer to the current namespace definition
5523  *	(or internally %NULL if the current namespace is unknown)
5524  * @is_radiotap_ns: indicates whether the current namespace is the default
5525  *	radiotap namespace or not
5526  *
5527  * @_rtheader: pointer to the radiotap header we are walking through
5528  * @_max_length: length of radiotap header in cpu byte ordering
5529  * @_arg_index: next argument index
5530  * @_arg: next argument pointer
5531  * @_next_bitmap: internal pointer to next present u32
5532  * @_bitmap_shifter: internal shifter for curr u32 bitmap, b0 set == arg present
5533  * @_vns: vendor namespace definitions
5534  * @_next_ns_data: beginning of the next namespace's data
5535  * @_reset_on_ext: internal; reset the arg index to 0 when going to the
5536  *	next bitmap word
5537  *
5538  * Describes the radiotap parser state. Fields prefixed with an underscore
5539  * must not be used by users of the parser, only by the parser internally.
5540  */
5541 
5542 struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator {
5543 	struct ieee80211_radiotap_header *_rtheader;
5544 	const struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces *_vns;
5545 	const struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace *current_namespace;
5546 
5547 	unsigned char *_arg, *_next_ns_data;
5548 	__le32 *_next_bitmap;
5549 
5550 	unsigned char *this_arg;
5551 	int this_arg_index;
5552 	int this_arg_size;
5553 
5554 	int is_radiotap_ns;
5555 
5556 	int _max_length;
5557 	int _arg_index;
5558 	uint32_t _bitmap_shifter;
5559 	int _reset_on_ext;
5560 };
5561 
5562 int
5563 ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_init(struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator *iterator,
5564 				 struct ieee80211_radiotap_header *radiotap_header,
5565 				 int max_length,
5566 				 const struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces *vns);
5567 
5568 int
5569 ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next(struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator *iterator);
5570 
5571 
5572 extern const unsigned char rfc1042_header[6];
5573 extern const unsigned char bridge_tunnel_header[6];
5574 
5575 /**
5576  * ieee80211_get_hdrlen_from_skb - get header length from data
5577  *
5578  * @skb: the frame
5579  *
5580  * Given an skb with a raw 802.11 header at the data pointer this function
5581  * returns the 802.11 header length.
5582  *
5583  * Return: The 802.11 header length in bytes (not including encryption
5584  * headers). Or 0 if the data in the sk_buff is too short to contain a valid
5585  * 802.11 header.
5586  */
5587 unsigned int ieee80211_get_hdrlen_from_skb(const struct sk_buff *skb);
5588 
5589 /**
5590  * ieee80211_hdrlen - get header length in bytes from frame control
5591  * @fc: frame control field in little-endian format
5592  * Return: The header length in bytes.
5593  */
5594 unsigned int __attribute_const__ ieee80211_hdrlen(__le16 fc);
5595 
5596 /**
5597  * ieee80211_get_mesh_hdrlen - get mesh extension header length
5598  * @meshhdr: the mesh extension header, only the flags field
5599  *	(first byte) will be accessed
5600  * Return: The length of the extension header, which is always at
5601  * least 6 bytes and at most 18 if address 5 and 6 are present.
5602  */
5603 unsigned int ieee80211_get_mesh_hdrlen(struct ieee80211s_hdr *meshhdr);
5604 
5605 /**
5606  * DOC: Data path helpers
5607  *
5608  * In addition to generic utilities, cfg80211 also offers
5609  * functions that help implement the data path for devices
5610  * that do not do the 802.11/802.3 conversion on the device.
5611  */
5612 
5613 /**
5614  * ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr - convert an 802.11 data frame to 802.3
5615  * @skb: the 802.11 data frame
5616  * @ehdr: pointer to a &struct ethhdr that will get the header, instead
5617  *	of it being pushed into the SKB
5618  * @addr: the device MAC address
5619  * @iftype: the virtual interface type
5620  * @data_offset: offset of payload after the 802.11 header
5621  * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
5622  */
5623 int ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr(struct sk_buff *skb, struct ethhdr *ehdr,
5624 				  const u8 *addr, enum nl80211_iftype iftype,
5625 				  u8 data_offset, bool is_amsdu);
5626 
5627 /**
5628  * ieee80211_data_to_8023 - convert an 802.11 data frame to 802.3
5629  * @skb: the 802.11 data frame
5630  * @addr: the device MAC address
5631  * @iftype: the virtual interface type
5632  * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
5633  */
ieee80211_data_to_8023(struct sk_buff * skb,const u8 * addr,enum nl80211_iftype iftype)5634 static inline int ieee80211_data_to_8023(struct sk_buff *skb, const u8 *addr,
5635 					 enum nl80211_iftype iftype)
5636 {
5637 	return ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr(skb, NULL, addr, iftype, 0, false);
5638 }
5639 
5640 /**
5641  * ieee80211_amsdu_to_8023s - decode an IEEE 802.11n A-MSDU frame
5642  *
5643  * Decode an IEEE 802.11 A-MSDU and convert it to a list of 802.3 frames.
5644  * The @list will be empty if the decode fails. The @skb must be fully
5645  * header-less before being passed in here; it is freed in this function.
5646  *
5647  * @skb: The input A-MSDU frame without any headers.
5648  * @list: The output list of 802.3 frames. It must be allocated and
5649  *	initialized by the caller.
5650  * @addr: The device MAC address.
5651  * @iftype: The device interface type.
5652  * @extra_headroom: The hardware extra headroom for SKBs in the @list.
5653  * @check_da: DA to check in the inner ethernet header, or NULL
5654  * @check_sa: SA to check in the inner ethernet header, or NULL
5655  */
5656 void ieee80211_amsdu_to_8023s(struct sk_buff *skb, struct sk_buff_head *list,
5657 			      const u8 *addr, enum nl80211_iftype iftype,
5658 			      const unsigned int extra_headroom,
5659 			      const u8 *check_da, const u8 *check_sa);
5660 
5661 /**
5662  * cfg80211_classify8021d - determine the 802.1p/1d tag for a data frame
5663  * @skb: the data frame
5664  * @qos_map: Interworking QoS mapping or %NULL if not in use
5665  * Return: The 802.1p/1d tag.
5666  */
5667 unsigned int cfg80211_classify8021d(struct sk_buff *skb,
5668 				    struct cfg80211_qos_map *qos_map);
5669 
5670 /**
5671  * cfg80211_find_elem_match - match information element and byte array in data
5672  *
5673  * @eid: element ID
5674  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
5675  * @len: length of data
5676  * @match: byte array to match
5677  * @match_len: number of bytes in the match array
5678  * @match_offset: offset in the IE data where the byte array should match.
5679  *	Note the difference to cfg80211_find_ie_match() which considers
5680  *	the offset to start from the element ID byte, but here we take
5681  *	the data portion instead.
5682  *
5683  * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if
5684  * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
5685  * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the
5686  * requested element struct.
5687  *
5688  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
5689  * having to fit into the given data and being large enough for the
5690  * byte array to match.
5691  */
5692 const struct element *
5693 cfg80211_find_elem_match(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, unsigned int len,
5694 			 const u8 *match, unsigned int match_len,
5695 			 unsigned int match_offset);
5696 
5697 /**
5698  * cfg80211_find_ie_match - match information element and byte array in data
5699  *
5700  * @eid: element ID
5701  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
5702  * @len: length of data
5703  * @match: byte array to match
5704  * @match_len: number of bytes in the match array
5705  * @match_offset: offset in the IE where the byte array should match.
5706  *	If match_len is zero, this must also be set to zero.
5707  *	Otherwise this must be set to 2 or more, because the first
5708  *	byte is the element id, which is already compared to eid, and
5709  *	the second byte is the IE length.
5710  *
5711  * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if
5712  * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
5713  * data) or if the byte array doesn't match, or a pointer to the first
5714  * byte of the requested element, that is the byte containing the
5715  * element ID.
5716  *
5717  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
5718  * having to fit into the given data and being large enough for the
5719  * byte array to match.
5720  */
5721 static inline const u8 *
cfg80211_find_ie_match(u8 eid,const u8 * ies,unsigned int len,const u8 * match,unsigned int match_len,unsigned int match_offset)5722 cfg80211_find_ie_match(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, unsigned int len,
5723 		       const u8 *match, unsigned int match_len,
5724 		       unsigned int match_offset)
5725 {
5726 	/* match_offset can't be smaller than 2, unless match_len is
5727 	 * zero, in which case match_offset must be zero as well.
5728 	 */
5729 	if (WARN_ON((match_len && match_offset < 2) ||
5730 		    (!match_len && match_offset)))
5731 		return NULL;
5732 
5733 	return (void *)cfg80211_find_elem_match(eid, ies, len,
5734 						match, match_len,
5735 						match_offset ?
5736 							match_offset - 2 : 0);
5737 }
5738 
5739 /**
5740  * cfg80211_find_elem - find information element in data
5741  *
5742  * @eid: element ID
5743  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
5744  * @len: length of data
5745  *
5746  * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if
5747  * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
5748  * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the
5749  * requested element struct.
5750  *
5751  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
5752  * having to fit into the given data.
5753  */
5754 static inline const struct element *
cfg80211_find_elem(u8 eid,const u8 * ies,int len)5755 cfg80211_find_elem(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, int len)
5756 {
5757 	return cfg80211_find_elem_match(eid, ies, len, NULL, 0, 0);
5758 }
5759 
5760 /**
5761  * cfg80211_find_ie - find information element in data
5762  *
5763  * @eid: element ID
5764  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
5765  * @len: length of data
5766  *
5767  * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if
5768  * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
5769  * data), or a pointer to the first byte of the requested
5770  * element, that is the byte containing the element ID.
5771  *
5772  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
5773  * having to fit into the given data.
5774  */
cfg80211_find_ie(u8 eid,const u8 * ies,int len)5775 static inline const u8 *cfg80211_find_ie(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, int len)
5776 {
5777 	return cfg80211_find_ie_match(eid, ies, len, NULL, 0, 0);
5778 }
5779 
5780 /**
5781  * cfg80211_find_ext_elem - find information element with EID Extension in data
5782  *
5783  * @ext_eid: element ID Extension
5784  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
5785  * @len: length of data
5786  *
5787  * Return: %NULL if the etended element could not be found or if
5788  * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
5789  * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the
5790  * requested element struct.
5791  *
5792  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
5793  * having to fit into the given data.
5794  */
5795 static inline const struct element *
cfg80211_find_ext_elem(u8 ext_eid,const u8 * ies,int len)5796 cfg80211_find_ext_elem(u8 ext_eid, const u8 *ies, int len)
5797 {
5798 	return cfg80211_find_elem_match(WLAN_EID_EXTENSION, ies, len,
5799 					&ext_eid, 1, 0);
5800 }
5801 
5802 /**
5803  * cfg80211_find_ext_ie - find information element with EID Extension in data
5804  *
5805  * @ext_eid: element ID Extension
5806  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
5807  * @len: length of data
5808  *
5809  * Return: %NULL if the extended element ID could not be found or if
5810  * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
5811  * data), or a pointer to the first byte of the requested
5812  * element, that is the byte containing the element ID.
5813  *
5814  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
5815  * having to fit into the given data.
5816  */
cfg80211_find_ext_ie(u8 ext_eid,const u8 * ies,int len)5817 static inline const u8 *cfg80211_find_ext_ie(u8 ext_eid, const u8 *ies, int len)
5818 {
5819 	return cfg80211_find_ie_match(WLAN_EID_EXTENSION, ies, len,
5820 				      &ext_eid, 1, 2);
5821 }
5822 
5823 /**
5824  * cfg80211_find_vendor_elem - find vendor specific information element in data
5825  *
5826  * @oui: vendor OUI
5827  * @oui_type: vendor-specific OUI type (must be < 0xff), negative means any
5828  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
5829  * @len: length of data
5830  *
5831  * Return: %NULL if the vendor specific element ID could not be found or if the
5832  * element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given data); otherwise
5833  * return the element structure for the requested element.
5834  *
5835  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than having to fit into
5836  * the given data.
5837  */
5838 const struct element *cfg80211_find_vendor_elem(unsigned int oui, int oui_type,
5839 						const u8 *ies,
5840 						unsigned int len);
5841 
5842 /**
5843  * cfg80211_find_vendor_ie - find vendor specific information element in data
5844  *
5845  * @oui: vendor OUI
5846  * @oui_type: vendor-specific OUI type (must be < 0xff), negative means any
5847  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
5848  * @len: length of data
5849  *
5850  * Return: %NULL if the vendor specific element ID could not be found or if the
5851  * element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given data), or a pointer to
5852  * the first byte of the requested element, that is the byte containing the
5853  * element ID.
5854  *
5855  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than having to fit into
5856  * the given data.
5857  */
5858 static inline const u8 *
cfg80211_find_vendor_ie(unsigned int oui,int oui_type,const u8 * ies,unsigned int len)5859 cfg80211_find_vendor_ie(unsigned int oui, int oui_type,
5860 			const u8 *ies, unsigned int len)
5861 {
5862 	return (void *)cfg80211_find_vendor_elem(oui, oui_type, ies, len);
5863 }
5864 
5865 /**
5866  * cfg80211_send_layer2_update - send layer 2 update frame
5867  *
5868  * @dev: network device
5869  * @addr: STA MAC address
5870  *
5871  * Wireless drivers can use this function to update forwarding tables in bridge
5872  * devices upon STA association.
5873  */
5874 void cfg80211_send_layer2_update(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr);
5875 
5876 /**
5877  * DOC: Regulatory enforcement infrastructure
5878  *
5879  * TODO
5880  */
5881 
5882 /**
5883  * regulatory_hint - driver hint to the wireless core a regulatory domain
5884  * @wiphy: the wireless device giving the hint (used only for reporting
5885  *	conflicts)
5886  * @alpha2: the ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 the driver claims its regulatory domain
5887  *	should be in. If @rd is set this should be NULL. Note that if you
5888  *	set this to NULL you should still set rd->alpha2 to some accepted
5889  *	alpha2.
5890  *
5891  * Wireless drivers can use this function to hint to the wireless core
5892  * what it believes should be the current regulatory domain by
5893  * giving it an ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 country code it knows its regulatory
5894  * domain should be in or by providing a completely build regulatory domain.
5895  * If the driver provides an ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 userspace will be queried
5896  * for a regulatory domain structure for the respective country.
5897  *
5898  * The wiphy must have been registered to cfg80211 prior to this call.
5899  * For cfg80211 drivers this means you must first use wiphy_register(),
5900  * for mac80211 drivers you must first use ieee80211_register_hw().
5901  *
5902  * Drivers should check the return value, its possible you can get
5903  * an -ENOMEM.
5904  *
5905  * Return: 0 on success. -ENOMEM.
5906  */
5907 int regulatory_hint(struct wiphy *wiphy, const char *alpha2);
5908 
5909 /**
5910  * regulatory_set_wiphy_regd - set regdom info for self managed drivers
5911  * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on
5912  * @rd: the regulatory domain informatoin to use for this wiphy
5913  *
5914  * Set the regulatory domain information for self-managed wiphys, only they
5915  * may use this function. See %REGULATORY_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED for more
5916  * information.
5917  *
5918  * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL, -EPERM
5919  */
5920 int regulatory_set_wiphy_regd(struct wiphy *wiphy,
5921 			      struct ieee80211_regdomain *rd);
5922 
5923 /**
5924  * regulatory_set_wiphy_regd_sync_rtnl - set regdom for self-managed drivers
5925  * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on
5926  * @rd: the regulatory domain information to use for this wiphy
5927  *
5928  * This functions requires the RTNL to be held and applies the new regdomain
5929  * synchronously to this wiphy. For more details see
5930  * regulatory_set_wiphy_regd().
5931  *
5932  * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL, -EPERM
5933  */
5934 int regulatory_set_wiphy_regd_sync_rtnl(struct wiphy *wiphy,
5935 					struct ieee80211_regdomain *rd);
5936 
5937 /**
5938  * wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory - apply a custom driver regulatory domain
5939  * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on
5940  * @regd: the custom regulatory domain to use for this wiphy
5941  *
5942  * Drivers can sometimes have custom regulatory domains which do not apply
5943  * to a specific country. Drivers can use this to apply such custom regulatory
5944  * domains. This routine must be called prior to wiphy registration. The
5945  * custom regulatory domain will be trusted completely and as such previous
5946  * default channel settings will be disregarded. If no rule is found for a
5947  * channel on the regulatory domain the channel will be disabled.
5948  * Drivers using this for a wiphy should also set the wiphy flag
5949  * REGULATORY_CUSTOM_REG or cfg80211 will set it for the wiphy
5950  * that called this helper.
5951  */
5952 void wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory(struct wiphy *wiphy,
5953 				   const struct ieee80211_regdomain *regd);
5954 
5955 /**
5956  * freq_reg_info - get regulatory information for the given frequency
5957  * @wiphy: the wiphy for which we want to process this rule for
5958  * @center_freq: Frequency in KHz for which we want regulatory information for
5959  *
5960  * Use this function to get the regulatory rule for a specific frequency on
5961  * a given wireless device. If the device has a specific regulatory domain
5962  * it wants to follow we respect that unless a country IE has been received
5963  * and processed already.
5964  *
5965  * Return: A valid pointer, or, when an error occurs, for example if no rule
5966  * can be found, the return value is encoded using ERR_PTR(). Use IS_ERR() to
5967  * check and PTR_ERR() to obtain the numeric return value. The numeric return
5968  * value will be -ERANGE if we determine the given center_freq does not even
5969  * have a regulatory rule for a frequency range in the center_freq's band.
5970  * See freq_in_rule_band() for our current definition of a band -- this is
5971  * purely subjective and right now it's 802.11 specific.
5972  */
5973 const struct ieee80211_reg_rule *freq_reg_info(struct wiphy *wiphy,
5974 					       u32 center_freq);
5975 
5976 /**
5977  * reg_initiator_name - map regulatory request initiator enum to name
5978  * @initiator: the regulatory request initiator
5979  *
5980  * You can use this to map the regulatory request initiator enum to a
5981  * proper string representation.
5982  */
5983 const char *reg_initiator_name(enum nl80211_reg_initiator initiator);
5984 
5985 /**
5986  * regulatory_pre_cac_allowed - check if pre-CAC allowed in the current regdom
5987  * @wiphy: wiphy for which pre-CAC capability is checked.
5988  *
5989  * Pre-CAC is allowed only in some regdomains (notable ETSI).
5990  */
5991 bool regulatory_pre_cac_allowed(struct wiphy *wiphy);
5992 
5993 /**
5994  * DOC: Internal regulatory db functions
5995  *
5996  */
5997 
5998 /**
5999  * reg_query_regdb_wmm -  Query internal regulatory db for wmm rule
6000  * Regulatory self-managed driver can use it to proactively
6001  *
6002  * @alpha2: the ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 wmm rule to be queried.
6003  * @freq: the freqency(in MHz) to be queried.
6004  * @rule: pointer to store the wmm rule from the regulatory db.
6005  *
6006  * Self-managed wireless drivers can use this function to  query
6007  * the internal regulatory database to check whether the given
6008  * ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 country and freq have wmm rule limitations.
6009  *
6010  * Drivers should check the return value, its possible you can get
6011  * an -ENODATA.
6012  *
6013  * Return: 0 on success. -ENODATA.
6014  */
6015 int reg_query_regdb_wmm(char *alpha2, int freq,
6016 			struct ieee80211_reg_rule *rule);
6017 
6018 /*
6019  * callbacks for asynchronous cfg80211 methods, notification
6020  * functions and BSS handling helpers
6021  */
6022 
6023 /**
6024  * cfg80211_scan_done - notify that scan finished
6025  *
6026  * @request: the corresponding scan request
6027  * @info: information about the completed scan
6028  */
6029 void cfg80211_scan_done(struct cfg80211_scan_request *request,
6030 			struct cfg80211_scan_info *info);
6031 
6032 /**
6033  * cfg80211_sched_scan_results - notify that new scan results are available
6034  *
6035  * @wiphy: the wiphy which got scheduled scan results
6036  * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request
6037  */
6038 void cfg80211_sched_scan_results(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid);
6039 
6040 /**
6041  * cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped - notify that the scheduled scan has stopped
6042  *
6043  * @wiphy: the wiphy on which the scheduled scan stopped
6044  * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request
6045  *
6046  * The driver can call this function to inform cfg80211 that the
6047  * scheduled scan had to be stopped, for whatever reason.  The driver
6048  * is then called back via the sched_scan_stop operation when done.
6049  */
6050 void cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid);
6051 
6052 /**
6053  * cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped_rtnl - notify that the scheduled scan has stopped
6054  *
6055  * @wiphy: the wiphy on which the scheduled scan stopped
6056  * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request
6057  *
6058  * The driver can call this function to inform cfg80211 that the
6059  * scheduled scan had to be stopped, for whatever reason.  The driver
6060  * is then called back via the sched_scan_stop operation when done.
6061  * This function should be called with rtnl locked.
6062  */
6063 void cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped_rtnl(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid);
6064 
6065 /**
6066  * cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data - inform cfg80211 of a received BSS frame
6067  * @wiphy: the wiphy reporting the BSS
6068  * @data: the BSS metadata
6069  * @mgmt: the management frame (probe response or beacon)
6070  * @len: length of the management frame
6071  * @gfp: context flags
6072  *
6073  * This informs cfg80211 that BSS information was found and
6074  * the BSS should be updated/added.
6075  *
6076  * Return: A referenced struct, must be released with cfg80211_put_bss()!
6077  * Or %NULL on error.
6078  */
6079 struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
6080 cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6081 			       struct cfg80211_inform_bss *data,
6082 			       struct ieee80211_mgmt *mgmt, size_t len,
6083 			       gfp_t gfp);
6084 
6085 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
cfg80211_inform_bss_width_frame(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct ieee80211_channel * rx_channel,enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width,struct ieee80211_mgmt * mgmt,size_t len,s32 signal,gfp_t gfp)6086 cfg80211_inform_bss_width_frame(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6087 				struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel,
6088 				enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width,
6089 				struct ieee80211_mgmt *mgmt, size_t len,
6090 				s32 signal, gfp_t gfp)
6091 {
6092 	struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = {
6093 		.chan = rx_channel,
6094 		.scan_width = scan_width,
6095 		.signal = signal,
6096 	};
6097 
6098 	return cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data(wiphy, &data, mgmt, len, gfp);
6099 }
6100 
6101 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
cfg80211_inform_bss_frame(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct ieee80211_channel * rx_channel,struct ieee80211_mgmt * mgmt,size_t len,s32 signal,gfp_t gfp)6102 cfg80211_inform_bss_frame(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6103 			  struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel,
6104 			  struct ieee80211_mgmt *mgmt, size_t len,
6105 			  s32 signal, gfp_t gfp)
6106 {
6107 	struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = {
6108 		.chan = rx_channel,
6109 		.scan_width = NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20,
6110 		.signal = signal,
6111 	};
6112 
6113 	return cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data(wiphy, &data, mgmt, len, gfp);
6114 }
6115 
6116 /**
6117  * cfg80211_gen_new_bssid - generate a nontransmitted BSSID for multi-BSSID
6118  * @bssid: transmitter BSSID
6119  * @max_bssid: max BSSID indicator, taken from Multiple BSSID element
6120  * @mbssid_index: BSSID index, taken from Multiple BSSID index element
6121  * @new_bssid: calculated nontransmitted BSSID
6122  */
cfg80211_gen_new_bssid(const u8 * bssid,u8 max_bssid,u8 mbssid_index,u8 * new_bssid)6123 static inline void cfg80211_gen_new_bssid(const u8 *bssid, u8 max_bssid,
6124 					  u8 mbssid_index, u8 *new_bssid)
6125 {
6126 	u64 bssid_u64 = ether_addr_to_u64(bssid);
6127 	u64 mask = GENMASK_ULL(max_bssid - 1, 0);
6128 	u64 new_bssid_u64;
6129 
6130 	new_bssid_u64 = bssid_u64 & ~mask;
6131 
6132 	new_bssid_u64 |= ((bssid_u64 & mask) + mbssid_index) & mask;
6133 
6134 	u64_to_ether_addr(new_bssid_u64, new_bssid);
6135 }
6136 
6137 /**
6138  * cfg80211_is_element_inherited - returns if element ID should be inherited
6139  * @element: element to check
6140  * @non_inherit_element: non inheritance element
6141  */
6142 bool cfg80211_is_element_inherited(const struct element *element,
6143 				   const struct element *non_inherit_element);
6144 
6145 /**
6146  * cfg80211_merge_profile - merges a MBSSID profile if it is split between IEs
6147  * @ie: ies
6148  * @ielen: length of IEs
6149  * @mbssid_elem: current MBSSID element
6150  * @sub_elem: current MBSSID subelement (profile)
6151  * @merged_ie: location of the merged profile
6152  * @max_copy_len: max merged profile length
6153  */
6154 size_t cfg80211_merge_profile(const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
6155 			      const struct element *mbssid_elem,
6156 			      const struct element *sub_elem,
6157 			      u8 *merged_ie, size_t max_copy_len);
6158 
6159 /**
6160  * enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type - frame type that the BSS data came from
6161  * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_UNKNOWN: driver doesn't know whether the data is
6162  *	from a beacon or probe response
6163  * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_BEACON: data comes from a beacon
6164  * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_PRESP: data comes from a probe response
6165  */
6166 enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type {
6167 	CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_UNKNOWN,
6168 	CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_BEACON,
6169 	CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_PRESP,
6170 };
6171 
6172 /**
6173  * cfg80211_inform_bss_data - inform cfg80211 of a new BSS
6174  *
6175  * @wiphy: the wiphy reporting the BSS
6176  * @data: the BSS metadata
6177  * @ftype: frame type (if known)
6178  * @bssid: the BSSID of the BSS
6179  * @tsf: the TSF sent by the peer in the beacon/probe response (or 0)
6180  * @capability: the capability field sent by the peer
6181  * @beacon_interval: the beacon interval announced by the peer
6182  * @ie: additional IEs sent by the peer
6183  * @ielen: length of the additional IEs
6184  * @gfp: context flags
6185  *
6186  * This informs cfg80211 that BSS information was found and
6187  * the BSS should be updated/added.
6188  *
6189  * Return: A referenced struct, must be released with cfg80211_put_bss()!
6190  * Or %NULL on error.
6191  */
6192 struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
6193 cfg80211_inform_bss_data(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6194 			 struct cfg80211_inform_bss *data,
6195 			 enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype,
6196 			 const u8 *bssid, u64 tsf, u16 capability,
6197 			 u16 beacon_interval, const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
6198 			 gfp_t gfp);
6199 
6200 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
cfg80211_inform_bss_width(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct ieee80211_channel * rx_channel,enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width,enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype,const u8 * bssid,u64 tsf,u16 capability,u16 beacon_interval,const u8 * ie,size_t ielen,s32 signal,gfp_t gfp)6201 cfg80211_inform_bss_width(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6202 			  struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel,
6203 			  enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width,
6204 			  enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype,
6205 			  const u8 *bssid, u64 tsf, u16 capability,
6206 			  u16 beacon_interval, const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
6207 			  s32 signal, gfp_t gfp)
6208 {
6209 	struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = {
6210 		.chan = rx_channel,
6211 		.scan_width = scan_width,
6212 		.signal = signal,
6213 	};
6214 
6215 	return cfg80211_inform_bss_data(wiphy, &data, ftype, bssid, tsf,
6216 					capability, beacon_interval, ie, ielen,
6217 					gfp);
6218 }
6219 
6220 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
cfg80211_inform_bss(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct ieee80211_channel * rx_channel,enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype,const u8 * bssid,u64 tsf,u16 capability,u16 beacon_interval,const u8 * ie,size_t ielen,s32 signal,gfp_t gfp)6221 cfg80211_inform_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6222 		    struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel,
6223 		    enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype,
6224 		    const u8 *bssid, u64 tsf, u16 capability,
6225 		    u16 beacon_interval, const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
6226 		    s32 signal, gfp_t gfp)
6227 {
6228 	struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = {
6229 		.chan = rx_channel,
6230 		.scan_width = NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20,
6231 		.signal = signal,
6232 	};
6233 
6234 	return cfg80211_inform_bss_data(wiphy, &data, ftype, bssid, tsf,
6235 					capability, beacon_interval, ie, ielen,
6236 					gfp);
6237 }
6238 
6239 /**
6240  * cfg80211_get_bss - get a BSS reference
6241  * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to
6242  * @channel: the channel to search on (or %NULL)
6243  * @bssid: the desired BSSID (or %NULL)
6244  * @ssid: the desired SSID (or %NULL)
6245  * @ssid_len: length of the SSID (or 0)
6246  * @bss_type: type of BSS, see &enum ieee80211_bss_type
6247  * @privacy: privacy filter, see &enum ieee80211_privacy
6248  */
6249 struct cfg80211_bss *cfg80211_get_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6250 				      struct ieee80211_channel *channel,
6251 				      const u8 *bssid,
6252 				      const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len,
6253 				      enum ieee80211_bss_type bss_type,
6254 				      enum ieee80211_privacy privacy);
6255 static inline struct cfg80211_bss *
cfg80211_get_ibss(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct ieee80211_channel * channel,const u8 * ssid,size_t ssid_len)6256 cfg80211_get_ibss(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6257 		  struct ieee80211_channel *channel,
6258 		  const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len)
6259 {
6260 	return cfg80211_get_bss(wiphy, channel, NULL, ssid, ssid_len,
6261 				IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS,
6262 				IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY);
6263 }
6264 
6265 /**
6266  * cfg80211_ref_bss - reference BSS struct
6267  * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to
6268  * @bss: the BSS struct to reference
6269  *
6270  * Increments the refcount of the given BSS struct.
6271  */
6272 void cfg80211_ref_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss);
6273 
6274 /**
6275  * cfg80211_put_bss - unref BSS struct
6276  * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to
6277  * @bss: the BSS struct
6278  *
6279  * Decrements the refcount of the given BSS struct.
6280  */
6281 void cfg80211_put_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss);
6282 
6283 /**
6284  * cfg80211_unlink_bss - unlink BSS from internal data structures
6285  * @wiphy: the wiphy
6286  * @bss: the bss to remove
6287  *
6288  * This function removes the given BSS from the internal data structures
6289  * thereby making it no longer show up in scan results etc. Use this
6290  * function when you detect a BSS is gone. Normally BSSes will also time
6291  * out, so it is not necessary to use this function at all.
6292  */
6293 void cfg80211_unlink_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss);
6294 
6295 /**
6296  * cfg80211_bss_iter - iterate all BSS entries
6297  *
6298  * This function iterates over the BSS entries associated with the given wiphy
6299  * and calls the callback for the iterated BSS. The iterator function is not
6300  * allowed to call functions that might modify the internal state of the BSS DB.
6301  *
6302  * @wiphy: the wiphy
6303  * @chandef: if given, the iterator function will be called only if the channel
6304  *     of the currently iterated BSS is a subset of the given channel.
6305  * @iter: the iterator function to call
6306  * @iter_data: an argument to the iterator function
6307  */
6308 void cfg80211_bss_iter(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6309 		       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
6310 		       void (*iter)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6311 				    struct cfg80211_bss *bss,
6312 				    void *data),
6313 		       void *iter_data);
6314 
6315 static inline enum nl80211_bss_scan_width
cfg80211_chandef_to_scan_width(const struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef)6316 cfg80211_chandef_to_scan_width(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
6317 {
6318 	switch (chandef->width) {
6319 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5:
6320 		return NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_5;
6321 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10:
6322 		return NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_10;
6323 	default:
6324 		return NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20;
6325 	}
6326 }
6327 
6328 /**
6329  * cfg80211_rx_mlme_mgmt - notification of processed MLME management frame
6330  * @dev: network device
6331  * @buf: authentication frame (header + body)
6332  * @len: length of the frame data
6333  *
6334  * This function is called whenever an authentication, disassociation or
6335  * deauthentication frame has been received and processed in station mode.
6336  * After being asked to authenticate via cfg80211_ops::auth() the driver must
6337  * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout().
6338  * After being asked to associate via cfg80211_ops::assoc() the driver must
6339  * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout().
6340  * While connected, the driver must calls this for received and processed
6341  * disassociation and deauthentication frames. If the frame couldn't be used
6342  * because it was unprotected, the driver must call the function
6343  * cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt() instead.
6344  *
6345  * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex.
6346  */
6347 void cfg80211_rx_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *buf, size_t len);
6348 
6349 /**
6350  * cfg80211_auth_timeout - notification of timed out authentication
6351  * @dev: network device
6352  * @addr: The MAC address of the device with which the authentication timed out
6353  *
6354  * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's
6355  * mutex.
6356  */
6357 void cfg80211_auth_timeout(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr);
6358 
6359 /**
6360  * cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp - notification of processed association response
6361  * @dev: network device
6362  * @bss: the BSS that association was requested with, ownership of the pointer
6363  *	moves to cfg80211 in this call
6364  * @buf: (Re)Association Response frame (header + body)
6365  * @len: length of the frame data
6366  * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. Same format
6367  *	as the AC bitmap in the QoS info field
6368  * @req_ies: information elements from the (Re)Association Request frame
6369  * @req_ies_len: length of req_ies data
6370  *
6371  * After being asked to associate via cfg80211_ops::assoc() the driver must
6372  * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout().
6373  *
6374  * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex.
6375  */
6376 void cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp(struct net_device *dev,
6377 			    struct cfg80211_bss *bss,
6378 			    const u8 *buf, size_t len,
6379 			    int uapsd_queues,
6380 			    const u8 *req_ies, size_t req_ies_len);
6381 
6382 /**
6383  * cfg80211_assoc_timeout - notification of timed out association
6384  * @dev: network device
6385  * @bss: The BSS entry with which association timed out.
6386  *
6387  * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex.
6388  */
6389 void cfg80211_assoc_timeout(struct net_device *dev, struct cfg80211_bss *bss);
6390 
6391 /**
6392  * cfg80211_abandon_assoc - notify cfg80211 of abandoned association attempt
6393  * @dev: network device
6394  * @bss: The BSS entry with which association was abandoned.
6395  *
6396  * Call this whenever - for reasons reported through other API, like deauth RX,
6397  * an association attempt was abandoned.
6398  * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex.
6399  */
6400 void cfg80211_abandon_assoc(struct net_device *dev, struct cfg80211_bss *bss);
6401 
6402 /**
6403  * cfg80211_tx_mlme_mgmt - notification of transmitted deauth/disassoc frame
6404  * @dev: network device
6405  * @buf: 802.11 frame (header + body)
6406  * @len: length of the frame data
6407  *
6408  * This function is called whenever deauthentication has been processed in
6409  * station mode. This includes both received deauthentication frames and
6410  * locally generated ones. This function may sleep. The caller must hold the
6411  * corresponding wdev's mutex.
6412  */
6413 void cfg80211_tx_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *buf, size_t len);
6414 
6415 /**
6416  * cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt - notification of unprotected mlme mgmt frame
6417  * @dev: network device
6418  * @buf: received management frame (header + body)
6419  * @len: length of the frame data
6420  *
6421  * This function is called whenever a received deauthentication or dissassoc
6422  * frame has been dropped in station mode because of MFP being used but the
6423  * frame was not protected. This is also used to notify reception of a Beacon
6424  * frame that was dropped because it did not include a valid MME MIC while
6425  * beacon protection was enabled (BIGTK configured in station mode).
6426  *
6427  * This function may sleep.
6428  */
6429 void cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev,
6430 				  const u8 *buf, size_t len);
6431 
6432 /**
6433  * cfg80211_michael_mic_failure - notification of Michael MIC failure (TKIP)
6434  * @dev: network device
6435  * @addr: The source MAC address of the frame
6436  * @key_type: The key type that the received frame used
6437  * @key_id: Key identifier (0..3). Can be -1 if missing.
6438  * @tsc: The TSC value of the frame that generated the MIC failure (6 octets)
6439  * @gfp: allocation flags
6440  *
6441  * This function is called whenever the local MAC detects a MIC failure in a
6442  * received frame. This matches with MLME-MICHAELMICFAILURE.indication()
6443  * primitive.
6444  */
6445 void cfg80211_michael_mic_failure(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr,
6446 				  enum nl80211_key_type key_type, int key_id,
6447 				  const u8 *tsc, gfp_t gfp);
6448 
6449 /**
6450  * cfg80211_ibss_joined - notify cfg80211 that device joined an IBSS
6451  *
6452  * @dev: network device
6453  * @bssid: the BSSID of the IBSS joined
6454  * @channel: the channel of the IBSS joined
6455  * @gfp: allocation flags
6456  *
6457  * This function notifies cfg80211 that the device joined an IBSS or
6458  * switched to a different BSSID. Before this function can be called,
6459  * either a beacon has to have been received from the IBSS, or one of
6460  * the cfg80211_inform_bss{,_frame} functions must have been called
6461  * with the locally generated beacon -- this guarantees that there is
6462  * always a scan result for this IBSS. cfg80211 will handle the rest.
6463  */
6464 void cfg80211_ibss_joined(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
6465 			  struct ieee80211_channel *channel, gfp_t gfp);
6466 
6467 /**
6468  * cfg80211_notify_new_peer_candidate - notify cfg80211 of a new mesh peer
6469  * 					candidate
6470  *
6471  * @dev: network device
6472  * @macaddr: the MAC address of the new candidate
6473  * @ie: information elements advertised by the peer candidate
6474  * @ie_len: length of the information elements buffer
6475  * @gfp: allocation flags
6476  *
6477  * This function notifies cfg80211 that the mesh peer candidate has been
6478  * detected, most likely via a beacon or, less likely, via a probe response.
6479  * cfg80211 then sends a notification to userspace.
6480  */
6481 void cfg80211_notify_new_peer_candidate(struct net_device *dev,
6482 		const u8 *macaddr, const u8 *ie, u8 ie_len,
6483 		int sig_dbm, gfp_t gfp);
6484 
6485 /**
6486  * DOC: RFkill integration
6487  *
6488  * RFkill integration in cfg80211 is almost invisible to drivers,
6489  * as cfg80211 automatically registers an rfkill instance for each
6490  * wireless device it knows about. Soft kill is also translated
6491  * into disconnecting and turning all interfaces off, drivers are
6492  * expected to turn off the device when all interfaces are down.
6493  *
6494  * However, devices may have a hard RFkill line, in which case they
6495  * also need to interact with the rfkill subsystem, via cfg80211.
6496  * They can do this with a few helper functions documented here.
6497  */
6498 
6499 /**
6500  * wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state - notify cfg80211 about hw block state
6501  * @wiphy: the wiphy
6502  * @blocked: block status
6503  */
6504 void wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool blocked);
6505 
6506 /**
6507  * wiphy_rfkill_start_polling - start polling rfkill
6508  * @wiphy: the wiphy
6509  */
6510 void wiphy_rfkill_start_polling(struct wiphy *wiphy);
6511 
6512 /**
6513  * wiphy_rfkill_stop_polling - stop polling rfkill
6514  * @wiphy: the wiphy
6515  */
6516 void wiphy_rfkill_stop_polling(struct wiphy *wiphy);
6517 
6518 /**
6519  * DOC: Vendor commands
6520  *
6521  * Occasionally, there are special protocol or firmware features that
6522  * can't be implemented very openly. For this and similar cases, the
6523  * vendor command functionality allows implementing the features with
6524  * (typically closed-source) userspace and firmware, using nl80211 as
6525  * the configuration mechanism.
6526  *
6527  * A driver supporting vendor commands must register them as an array
6528  * in struct wiphy, with handlers for each one, each command has an
6529  * OUI and sub command ID to identify it.
6530  *
6531  * Note that this feature should not be (ab)used to implement protocol
6532  * features that could openly be shared across drivers. In particular,
6533  * it must never be required to use vendor commands to implement any
6534  * "normal" functionality that higher-level userspace like connection
6535  * managers etc. need.
6536  */
6537 
6538 struct sk_buff *__cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6539 					   enum nl80211_commands cmd,
6540 					   enum nl80211_attrs attr,
6541 					   int approxlen);
6542 
6543 struct sk_buff *__cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6544 					   struct wireless_dev *wdev,
6545 					   enum nl80211_commands cmd,
6546 					   enum nl80211_attrs attr,
6547 					   unsigned int portid,
6548 					   int vendor_event_idx,
6549 					   int approxlen, gfp_t gfp);
6550 
6551 void __cfg80211_send_event_skb(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp);
6552 
6553 /**
6554  * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb - allocate vendor command reply
6555  * @wiphy: the wiphy
6556  * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
6557  *	be put into the skb
6558  *
6559  * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for a reply to
6560  * a vendor command. Since it is intended for a reply, calling
6561  * it outside of a vendor command's doit() operation is invalid.
6562  *
6563  * The returned skb is pre-filled with some identifying data in
6564  * a way that any data that is put into the skb (with skb_put(),
6565  * nla_put() or similar) will end up being within the
6566  * %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA attribute, so all that needs to be done
6567  * with the skb is adding data for the corresponding userspace tool
6568  * which can then read that data out of the vendor data attribute.
6569  * You must not modify the skb in any other way.
6570  *
6571  * When done, call cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply() with the skb and return
6572  * its error code as the result of the doit() operation.
6573  *
6574  * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
6575  */
6576 static inline struct sk_buff *
cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy * wiphy,int approxlen)6577 cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen)
6578 {
6579 	return __cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(wiphy, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR,
6580 					  NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA, approxlen);
6581 }
6582 
6583 /**
6584  * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply - send the reply skb
6585  * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with
6586  *	cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb()
6587  *
6588  * Since calling this function will usually be the last thing
6589  * before returning from the vendor command doit() you should
6590  * return the error code.  Note that this function consumes the
6591  * skb regardless of the return value.
6592  *
6593  * Return: An error code or 0 on success.
6594  */
6595 int cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply(struct sk_buff *skb);
6596 
6597 /**
6598  * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender
6599  * @wiphy: the wiphy
6600  *
6601  * Return the current netlink port ID in a vendor command handler.
6602  * Valid to call only there.
6603  */
6604 unsigned int cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender(struct wiphy *wiphy);
6605 
6606 /**
6607  * cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc - allocate vendor-specific event skb
6608  * @wiphy: the wiphy
6609  * @wdev: the wireless device
6610  * @event_idx: index of the vendor event in the wiphy's vendor_events
6611  * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
6612  *	be put into the skb
6613  * @gfp: allocation flags
6614  *
6615  * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event on the
6616  * vendor-specific multicast group.
6617  *
6618  * If wdev != NULL, both the ifindex and identifier of the specified
6619  * wireless device are added to the event message before the vendor data
6620  * attribute.
6621  *
6622  * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_vendor_event() with the
6623  * skb to send the event.
6624  *
6625  * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
6626  */
6627 static inline struct sk_buff *
cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct wireless_dev * wdev,int approxlen,int event_idx,gfp_t gfp)6628 cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
6629 			     int approxlen, int event_idx, gfp_t gfp)
6630 {
6631 	return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, wdev, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR,
6632 					  NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA,
6633 					  0, event_idx, approxlen, gfp);
6634 }
6635 
6636 /**
6637  * cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc_ucast - alloc unicast vendor-specific event skb
6638  * @wiphy: the wiphy
6639  * @wdev: the wireless device
6640  * @event_idx: index of the vendor event in the wiphy's vendor_events
6641  * @portid: port ID of the receiver
6642  * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
6643  *	be put into the skb
6644  * @gfp: allocation flags
6645  *
6646  * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event to send to
6647  * a specific (userland) socket. This socket would previously have been
6648  * obtained by cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender(), and the caller MUST take
6649  * care to register a netlink notifier to see when the socket closes.
6650  *
6651  * If wdev != NULL, both the ifindex and identifier of the specified
6652  * wireless device are added to the event message before the vendor data
6653  * attribute.
6654  *
6655  * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_vendor_event() with the
6656  * skb to send the event.
6657  *
6658  * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
6659  */
6660 static inline struct sk_buff *
cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc_ucast(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct wireless_dev * wdev,unsigned int portid,int approxlen,int event_idx,gfp_t gfp)6661 cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc_ucast(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6662 				  struct wireless_dev *wdev,
6663 				  unsigned int portid, int approxlen,
6664 				  int event_idx, gfp_t gfp)
6665 {
6666 	return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, wdev, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR,
6667 					  NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA,
6668 					  portid, event_idx, approxlen, gfp);
6669 }
6670 
6671 /**
6672  * cfg80211_vendor_event - send the event
6673  * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc()
6674  * @gfp: allocation flags
6675  *
6676  * This function sends the given @skb, which must have been allocated
6677  * by cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc(), as an event. It always consumes it.
6678  */
cfg80211_vendor_event(struct sk_buff * skb,gfp_t gfp)6679 static inline void cfg80211_vendor_event(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp)
6680 {
6681 	__cfg80211_send_event_skb(skb, gfp);
6682 }
6683 
6684 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE
6685 /**
6686  * DOC: Test mode
6687  *
6688  * Test mode is a set of utility functions to allow drivers to
6689  * interact with driver-specific tools to aid, for instance,
6690  * factory programming.
6691  *
6692  * This chapter describes how drivers interact with it, for more
6693  * information see the nl80211 book's chapter on it.
6694  */
6695 
6696 /**
6697  * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb - allocate testmode reply
6698  * @wiphy: the wiphy
6699  * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
6700  *	be put into the skb
6701  *
6702  * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for a reply to
6703  * the testmode command. Since it is intended for a reply, calling
6704  * it outside of the @testmode_cmd operation is invalid.
6705  *
6706  * The returned skb is pre-filled with the wiphy index and set up in
6707  * a way that any data that is put into the skb (with skb_put(),
6708  * nla_put() or similar) will end up being within the
6709  * %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA attribute, so all that needs to be done
6710  * with the skb is adding data for the corresponding userspace tool
6711  * which can then read that data out of the testdata attribute. You
6712  * must not modify the skb in any other way.
6713  *
6714  * When done, call cfg80211_testmode_reply() with the skb and return
6715  * its error code as the result of the @testmode_cmd operation.
6716  *
6717  * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
6718  */
6719 static inline struct sk_buff *
cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy * wiphy,int approxlen)6720 cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen)
6721 {
6722 	return __cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(wiphy, NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE,
6723 					  NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA, approxlen);
6724 }
6725 
6726 /**
6727  * cfg80211_testmode_reply - send the reply skb
6728  * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with
6729  *	cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb()
6730  *
6731  * Since calling this function will usually be the last thing
6732  * before returning from the @testmode_cmd you should return
6733  * the error code.  Note that this function consumes the skb
6734  * regardless of the return value.
6735  *
6736  * Return: An error code or 0 on success.
6737  */
cfg80211_testmode_reply(struct sk_buff * skb)6738 static inline int cfg80211_testmode_reply(struct sk_buff *skb)
6739 {
6740 	return cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply(skb);
6741 }
6742 
6743 /**
6744  * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb - allocate testmode event
6745  * @wiphy: the wiphy
6746  * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
6747  *	be put into the skb
6748  * @gfp: allocation flags
6749  *
6750  * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event on the
6751  * testmode multicast group.
6752  *
6753  * The returned skb is set up in the same way as with
6754  * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb() but prepared for an event. As
6755  * there, you should simply add data to it that will then end up in the
6756  * %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA attribute. Again, you must not modify the skb
6757  * in any other way.
6758  *
6759  * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_testmode_event() with the
6760  * skb to send the event.
6761  *
6762  * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
6763  */
6764 static inline struct sk_buff *
cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb(struct wiphy * wiphy,int approxlen,gfp_t gfp)6765 cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen, gfp_t gfp)
6766 {
6767 	return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, NULL, NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE,
6768 					  NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA, 0, -1,
6769 					  approxlen, gfp);
6770 }
6771 
6772 /**
6773  * cfg80211_testmode_event - send the event
6774  * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with
6775  *	cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb()
6776  * @gfp: allocation flags
6777  *
6778  * This function sends the given @skb, which must have been allocated
6779  * by cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb(), as an event. It always
6780  * consumes it.
6781  */
cfg80211_testmode_event(struct sk_buff * skb,gfp_t gfp)6782 static inline void cfg80211_testmode_event(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp)
6783 {
6784 	__cfg80211_send_event_skb(skb, gfp);
6785 }
6786 
6787 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_CMD(cmd)	.testmode_cmd = (cmd),
6788 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_DUMP(cmd)	.testmode_dump = (cmd),
6789 #else
6790 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_CMD(cmd)
6791 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_DUMP(cmd)
6792 #endif
6793 
6794 /**
6795  * struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params - FILS connection response params
6796  * @kek: KEK derived from a successful FILS connection (may be %NULL)
6797  * @kek_len: Length of @fils_kek in octets
6798  * @update_erp_next_seq_num: Boolean value to specify whether the value in
6799  *	@erp_next_seq_num is valid.
6800  * @erp_next_seq_num: The next sequence number to use in ERP message in
6801  *	FILS Authentication. This value should be specified irrespective of the
6802  *	status for a FILS connection.
6803  * @pmk: A new PMK if derived from a successful FILS connection (may be %NULL).
6804  * @pmk_len: Length of @pmk in octets
6805  * @pmkid: A new PMKID if derived from a successful FILS connection or the PMKID
6806  *	used for this FILS connection (may be %NULL).
6807  */
6808 struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params {
6809 	const u8 *kek;
6810 	size_t kek_len;
6811 	bool update_erp_next_seq_num;
6812 	u16 erp_next_seq_num;
6813 	const u8 *pmk;
6814 	size_t pmk_len;
6815 	const u8 *pmkid;
6816 };
6817 
6818 /**
6819  * struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params - Connection response params
6820  * @status: Status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use
6821  *	%WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you
6822  *	the real status code for failures. If this call is used to report a
6823  *	failure due to a timeout (e.g., not receiving an Authentication frame
6824  *	from the AP) instead of an explicit rejection by the AP, -1 is used to
6825  *	indicate that this is a failure, but without a status code.
6826  *	@timeout_reason is used to report the reason for the timeout in that
6827  *	case.
6828  * @bssid: The BSSID of the AP (may be %NULL)
6829  * @bss: Entry of bss to which STA got connected to, can be obtained through
6830  *	cfg80211_get_bss() (may be %NULL). But it is recommended to store the
6831  *	bss from the connect_request and hold a reference to it and return
6832  *	through this param to avoid a warning if the bss is expired during the
6833  *	connection, esp. for those drivers implementing connect op.
6834  *	Only one parameter among @bssid and @bss needs to be specified.
6835  * @req_ie: Association request IEs (may be %NULL)
6836  * @req_ie_len: Association request IEs length
6837  * @resp_ie: Association response IEs (may be %NULL)
6838  * @resp_ie_len: Association response IEs length
6839  * @fils: FILS connection response parameters.
6840  * @timeout_reason: Reason for connection timeout. This is used when the
6841  *	connection fails due to a timeout instead of an explicit rejection from
6842  *	the AP. %NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED is used when the timeout reason is
6843  *	not known. This value is used only if @status < 0 to indicate that the
6844  *	failure is due to a timeout and not due to explicit rejection by the AP.
6845  *	This value is ignored in other cases (@status >= 0).
6846  */
6847 struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params {
6848 	int status;
6849 	const u8 *bssid;
6850 	struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
6851 	const u8 *req_ie;
6852 	size_t req_ie_len;
6853 	const u8 *resp_ie;
6854 	size_t resp_ie_len;
6855 	struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params fils;
6856 	enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason;
6857 };
6858 
6859 /**
6860  * cfg80211_connect_done - notify cfg80211 of connection result
6861  *
6862  * @dev: network device
6863  * @params: connection response parameters
6864  * @gfp: allocation flags
6865  *
6866  * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection
6867  * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to
6868  * cfg80211_connect_bss(), but takes a structure pointer for connection response
6869  * parameters. Only one of the functions among cfg80211_connect_bss(),
6870  * cfg80211_connect_result(), cfg80211_connect_timeout(),
6871  * and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called.
6872  */
6873 void cfg80211_connect_done(struct net_device *dev,
6874 			   struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params *params,
6875 			   gfp_t gfp);
6876 
6877 /**
6878  * cfg80211_connect_bss - notify cfg80211 of connection result
6879  *
6880  * @dev: network device
6881  * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP
6882  * @bss: Entry of bss to which STA got connected to, can be obtained through
6883  *	cfg80211_get_bss() (may be %NULL). But it is recommended to store the
6884  *	bss from the connect_request and hold a reference to it and return
6885  *	through this param to avoid a warning if the bss is expired during the
6886  *	connection, esp. for those drivers implementing connect op.
6887  *	Only one parameter among @bssid and @bss needs to be specified.
6888  * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL)
6889  * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length
6890  * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL)
6891  * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length
6892  * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use
6893  *	%WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you
6894  *	the real status code for failures. If this call is used to report a
6895  *	failure due to a timeout (e.g., not receiving an Authentication frame
6896  *	from the AP) instead of an explicit rejection by the AP, -1 is used to
6897  *	indicate that this is a failure, but without a status code.
6898  *	@timeout_reason is used to report the reason for the timeout in that
6899  *	case.
6900  * @gfp: allocation flags
6901  * @timeout_reason: reason for connection timeout. This is used when the
6902  *	connection fails due to a timeout instead of an explicit rejection from
6903  *	the AP. %NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED is used when the timeout reason is
6904  *	not known. This value is used only if @status < 0 to indicate that the
6905  *	failure is due to a timeout and not due to explicit rejection by the AP.
6906  *	This value is ignored in other cases (@status >= 0).
6907  *
6908  * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection
6909  * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to
6910  * cfg80211_connect_result(), but with the option of identifying the exact bss
6911  * entry for the connection. Only one of the functions among
6912  * cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(),
6913  * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called.
6914  */
6915 static inline void
cfg80211_connect_bss(struct net_device * dev,const u8 * bssid,struct cfg80211_bss * bss,const u8 * req_ie,size_t req_ie_len,const u8 * resp_ie,size_t resp_ie_len,int status,gfp_t gfp,enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason)6916 cfg80211_connect_bss(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
6917 		     struct cfg80211_bss *bss, const u8 *req_ie,
6918 		     size_t req_ie_len, const u8 *resp_ie,
6919 		     size_t resp_ie_len, int status, gfp_t gfp,
6920 		     enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason)
6921 {
6922 	struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params params;
6923 
6924 	memset(&params, 0, sizeof(params));
6925 	params.status = status;
6926 	params.bssid = bssid;
6927 	params.bss = bss;
6928 	params.req_ie = req_ie;
6929 	params.req_ie_len = req_ie_len;
6930 	params.resp_ie = resp_ie;
6931 	params.resp_ie_len = resp_ie_len;
6932 	params.timeout_reason = timeout_reason;
6933 
6934 	cfg80211_connect_done(dev, &params, gfp);
6935 }
6936 
6937 /**
6938  * cfg80211_connect_result - notify cfg80211 of connection result
6939  *
6940  * @dev: network device
6941  * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP
6942  * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL)
6943  * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length
6944  * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL)
6945  * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length
6946  * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use
6947  *	%WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you
6948  *	the real status code for failures.
6949  * @gfp: allocation flags
6950  *
6951  * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection
6952  * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to
6953  * cfg80211_connect_bss() which allows the exact bss entry to be specified. Only
6954  * one of the functions among cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(),
6955  * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called.
6956  */
6957 static inline void
cfg80211_connect_result(struct net_device * dev,const u8 * bssid,const u8 * req_ie,size_t req_ie_len,const u8 * resp_ie,size_t resp_ie_len,u16 status,gfp_t gfp)6958 cfg80211_connect_result(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
6959 			const u8 *req_ie, size_t req_ie_len,
6960 			const u8 *resp_ie, size_t resp_ie_len,
6961 			u16 status, gfp_t gfp)
6962 {
6963 	cfg80211_connect_bss(dev, bssid, NULL, req_ie, req_ie_len, resp_ie,
6964 			     resp_ie_len, status, gfp,
6965 			     NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED);
6966 }
6967 
6968 /**
6969  * cfg80211_connect_timeout - notify cfg80211 of connection timeout
6970  *
6971  * @dev: network device
6972  * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP
6973  * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL)
6974  * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length
6975  * @gfp: allocation flags
6976  * @timeout_reason: reason for connection timeout.
6977  *
6978  * It should be called by the underlying driver whenever connect() has failed
6979  * in a sequence where no explicit authentication/association rejection was
6980  * received from the AP. This could happen, e.g., due to not being able to send
6981  * out the Authentication or Association Request frame or timing out while
6982  * waiting for the response. Only one of the functions among
6983  * cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(),
6984  * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called.
6985  */
6986 static inline void
cfg80211_connect_timeout(struct net_device * dev,const u8 * bssid,const u8 * req_ie,size_t req_ie_len,gfp_t gfp,enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason)6987 cfg80211_connect_timeout(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
6988 			 const u8 *req_ie, size_t req_ie_len, gfp_t gfp,
6989 			 enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason)
6990 {
6991 	cfg80211_connect_bss(dev, bssid, NULL, req_ie, req_ie_len, NULL, 0, -1,
6992 			     gfp, timeout_reason);
6993 }
6994 
6995 /**
6996  * struct cfg80211_roam_info - driver initiated roaming information
6997  *
6998  * @channel: the channel of the new AP
6999  * @bss: entry of bss to which STA got roamed (may be %NULL if %bssid is set)
7000  * @bssid: the BSSID of the new AP (may be %NULL if %bss is set)
7001  * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL)
7002  * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length
7003  * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL)
7004  * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length
7005  * @fils: FILS related roaming information.
7006  */
7007 struct cfg80211_roam_info {
7008 	struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
7009 	struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
7010 	const u8 *bssid;
7011 	const u8 *req_ie;
7012 	size_t req_ie_len;
7013 	const u8 *resp_ie;
7014 	size_t resp_ie_len;
7015 	struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params fils;
7016 };
7017 
7018 /**
7019  * cfg80211_roamed - notify cfg80211 of roaming
7020  *
7021  * @dev: network device
7022  * @info: information about the new BSS. struct &cfg80211_roam_info.
7023  * @gfp: allocation flags
7024  *
7025  * This function may be called with the driver passing either the BSSID of the
7026  * new AP or passing the bss entry to avoid a race in timeout of the bss entry.
7027  * It should be called by the underlying driver whenever it roamed from one AP
7028  * to another while connected. Drivers which have roaming implemented in
7029  * firmware should pass the bss entry to avoid a race in bss entry timeout where
7030  * the bss entry of the new AP is seen in the driver, but gets timed out by the
7031  * time it is accessed in __cfg80211_roamed() due to delay in scheduling
7032  * rdev->event_work. In case of any failures, the reference is released
7033  * either in cfg80211_roamed() or in __cfg80211_romed(), Otherwise, it will be
7034  * released while disconnecting from the current bss.
7035  */
7036 void cfg80211_roamed(struct net_device *dev, struct cfg80211_roam_info *info,
7037 		     gfp_t gfp);
7038 
7039 /**
7040  * cfg80211_port_authorized - notify cfg80211 of successful security association
7041  *
7042  * @dev: network device
7043  * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP
7044  * @gfp: allocation flags
7045  *
7046  * This function should be called by a driver that supports 4 way handshake
7047  * offload after a security association was successfully established (i.e.,
7048  * the 4 way handshake was completed successfully). The call to this function
7049  * should be preceded with a call to cfg80211_connect_result(),
7050  * cfg80211_connect_done(), cfg80211_connect_bss() or cfg80211_roamed() to
7051  * indicate the 802.11 association.
7052  */
7053 void cfg80211_port_authorized(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
7054 			      gfp_t gfp);
7055 
7056 /**
7057  * cfg80211_disconnected - notify cfg80211 that connection was dropped
7058  *
7059  * @dev: network device
7060  * @ie: information elements of the deauth/disassoc frame (may be %NULL)
7061  * @ie_len: length of IEs
7062  * @reason: reason code for the disconnection, set it to 0 if unknown
7063  * @locally_generated: disconnection was requested locally
7064  * @gfp: allocation flags
7065  *
7066  * After it calls this function, the driver should enter an idle state
7067  * and not try to connect to any AP any more.
7068  */
7069 void cfg80211_disconnected(struct net_device *dev, u16 reason,
7070 			   const u8 *ie, size_t ie_len,
7071 			   bool locally_generated, gfp_t gfp);
7072 
7073 /**
7074  * cfg80211_ready_on_channel - notification of remain_on_channel start
7075  * @wdev: wireless device
7076  * @cookie: the request cookie
7077  * @chan: The current channel (from remain_on_channel request)
7078  * @duration: Duration in milliseconds that the driver intents to remain on the
7079  *	channel
7080  * @gfp: allocation flags
7081  */
7082 void cfg80211_ready_on_channel(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
7083 			       struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
7084 			       unsigned int duration, gfp_t gfp);
7085 
7086 /**
7087  * cfg80211_remain_on_channel_expired - remain_on_channel duration expired
7088  * @wdev: wireless device
7089  * @cookie: the request cookie
7090  * @chan: The current channel (from remain_on_channel request)
7091  * @gfp: allocation flags
7092  */
7093 void cfg80211_remain_on_channel_expired(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
7094 					struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
7095 					gfp_t gfp);
7096 
7097 /**
7098  * cfg80211_tx_mgmt_expired - tx_mgmt duration expired
7099  * @wdev: wireless device
7100  * @cookie: the requested cookie
7101  * @chan: The current channel (from tx_mgmt request)
7102  * @gfp: allocation flags
7103  */
7104 void cfg80211_tx_mgmt_expired(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
7105 			      struct ieee80211_channel *chan, gfp_t gfp);
7106 
7107 /**
7108  * cfg80211_sinfo_alloc_tid_stats - allocate per-tid statistics.
7109  *
7110  * @sinfo: the station information
7111  * @gfp: allocation flags
7112  */
7113 int cfg80211_sinfo_alloc_tid_stats(struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp);
7114 
7115 /**
7116  * cfg80211_sinfo_release_content - release contents of station info
7117  * @sinfo: the station information
7118  *
7119  * Releases any potentially allocated sub-information of the station
7120  * information, but not the struct itself (since it's typically on
7121  * the stack.)
7122  */
cfg80211_sinfo_release_content(struct station_info * sinfo)7123 static inline void cfg80211_sinfo_release_content(struct station_info *sinfo)
7124 {
7125 	kfree(sinfo->pertid);
7126 }
7127 
7128 /**
7129  * cfg80211_new_sta - notify userspace about station
7130  *
7131  * @dev: the netdev
7132  * @mac_addr: the station's address
7133  * @sinfo: the station information
7134  * @gfp: allocation flags
7135  */
7136 void cfg80211_new_sta(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr,
7137 		      struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp);
7138 
7139 /**
7140  * cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo - notify userspace about deletion of a station
7141  * @dev: the netdev
7142  * @mac_addr: the station's address
7143  * @sinfo: the station information/statistics
7144  * @gfp: allocation flags
7145  */
7146 void cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr,
7147 			    struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp);
7148 
7149 /**
7150  * cfg80211_del_sta - notify userspace about deletion of a station
7151  *
7152  * @dev: the netdev
7153  * @mac_addr: the station's address
7154  * @gfp: allocation flags
7155  */
cfg80211_del_sta(struct net_device * dev,const u8 * mac_addr,gfp_t gfp)7156 static inline void cfg80211_del_sta(struct net_device *dev,
7157 				    const u8 *mac_addr, gfp_t gfp)
7158 {
7159 	cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(dev, mac_addr, NULL, gfp);
7160 }
7161 
7162 /**
7163  * cfg80211_conn_failed - connection request failed notification
7164  *
7165  * @dev: the netdev
7166  * @mac_addr: the station's address
7167  * @reason: the reason for connection failure
7168  * @gfp: allocation flags
7169  *
7170  * Whenever a station tries to connect to an AP and if the station
7171  * could not connect to the AP as the AP has rejected the connection
7172  * for some reasons, this function is called.
7173  *
7174  * The reason for connection failure can be any of the value from
7175  * nl80211_connect_failed_reason enum
7176  */
7177 void cfg80211_conn_failed(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr,
7178 			  enum nl80211_connect_failed_reason reason,
7179 			  gfp_t gfp);
7180 
7181 /**
7182  * cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz - notification of received, unprocessed management frame
7183  * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
7184  * @freq: Frequency on which the frame was received in KHz
7185  * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
7186  * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
7187  * @len: length of the frame data
7188  * @flags: flags, as defined in enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags
7189  *
7190  * This function is called whenever an Action frame is received for a station
7191  * mode interface, but is not processed in kernel.
7192  *
7193  * Return: %true if a user space application has registered for this frame.
7194  * For action frames, that makes it responsible for rejecting unrecognized
7195  * action frames; %false otherwise, in which case for action frames the
7196  * driver is responsible for rejecting the frame.
7197  */
7198 bool cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz(struct wireless_dev *wdev, int freq, int sig_dbm,
7199 			  const u8 *buf, size_t len, u32 flags);
7200 
7201 /**
7202  * cfg80211_rx_mgmt - notification of received, unprocessed management frame
7203  * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
7204  * @freq: Frequency on which the frame was received in MHz
7205  * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
7206  * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
7207  * @len: length of the frame data
7208  * @flags: flags, as defined in enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags
7209  *
7210  * This function is called whenever an Action frame is received for a station
7211  * mode interface, but is not processed in kernel.
7212  *
7213  * Return: %true if a user space application has registered for this frame.
7214  * For action frames, that makes it responsible for rejecting unrecognized
7215  * action frames; %false otherwise, in which case for action frames the
7216  * driver is responsible for rejecting the frame.
7217  */
cfg80211_rx_mgmt(struct wireless_dev * wdev,int freq,int sig_dbm,const u8 * buf,size_t len,u32 flags)7218 static inline bool cfg80211_rx_mgmt(struct wireless_dev *wdev, int freq,
7219 				    int sig_dbm, const u8 *buf, size_t len,
7220 				    u32 flags)
7221 {
7222 	return cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz(wdev, MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq), sig_dbm, buf, len,
7223 				    flags);
7224 }
7225 
7226 /**
7227  * cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status - notification of TX status for management frame
7228  * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
7229  * @cookie: Cookie returned by cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx()
7230  * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
7231  * @len: length of the frame data
7232  * @ack: Whether frame was acknowledged
7233  * @gfp: context flags
7234  *
7235  * This function is called whenever a management frame was requested to be
7236  * transmitted with cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx() to report the TX status of the
7237  * transmission attempt.
7238  */
7239 void cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
7240 			     const u8 *buf, size_t len, bool ack, gfp_t gfp);
7241 
7242 /**
7243  * cfg80211_control_port_tx_status - notification of TX status for control
7244  *                                   port frames
7245  * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
7246  * @cookie: Cookie returned by cfg80211_ops::tx_control_port()
7247  * @buf: Data frame (header + body)
7248  * @len: length of the frame data
7249  * @ack: Whether frame was acknowledged
7250  * @gfp: context flags
7251  *
7252  * This function is called whenever a control port frame was requested to be
7253  * transmitted with cfg80211_ops::tx_control_port() to report the TX status of
7254  * the transmission attempt.
7255  */
7256 void cfg80211_control_port_tx_status(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
7257 				     const u8 *buf, size_t len, bool ack,
7258 				     gfp_t gfp);
7259 
7260 /**
7261  * cfg80211_rx_control_port - notification about a received control port frame
7262  * @dev: The device the frame matched to
7263  * @skb: The skbuf with the control port frame.  It is assumed that the skbuf
7264  *	is 802.3 formatted (with 802.3 header).  The skb can be non-linear.
7265  *	This function does not take ownership of the skb, so the caller is
7266  *	responsible for any cleanup.  The caller must also ensure that
7267  *	skb->protocol is set appropriately.
7268  * @unencrypted: Whether the frame was received unencrypted
7269  *
7270  * This function is used to inform userspace about a received control port
7271  * frame.  It should only be used if userspace indicated it wants to receive
7272  * control port frames over nl80211.
7273  *
7274  * The frame is the data portion of the 802.3 or 802.11 data frame with all
7275  * network layer headers removed (e.g. the raw EAPoL frame).
7276  *
7277  * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace
7278  */
7279 bool cfg80211_rx_control_port(struct net_device *dev,
7280 			      struct sk_buff *skb, bool unencrypted);
7281 
7282 /**
7283  * cfg80211_cqm_rssi_notify - connection quality monitoring rssi event
7284  * @dev: network device
7285  * @rssi_event: the triggered RSSI event
7286  * @rssi_level: new RSSI level value or 0 if not available
7287  * @gfp: context flags
7288  *
7289  * This function is called when a configured connection quality monitoring
7290  * rssi threshold reached event occurs.
7291  */
7292 void cfg80211_cqm_rssi_notify(struct net_device *dev,
7293 			      enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event rssi_event,
7294 			      s32 rssi_level, gfp_t gfp);
7295 
7296 /**
7297  * cfg80211_cqm_pktloss_notify - notify userspace about packetloss to peer
7298  * @dev: network device
7299  * @peer: peer's MAC address
7300  * @num_packets: how many packets were lost -- should be a fixed threshold
7301  *	but probably no less than maybe 50, or maybe a throughput dependent
7302  *	threshold (to account for temporary interference)
7303  * @gfp: context flags
7304  */
7305 void cfg80211_cqm_pktloss_notify(struct net_device *dev,
7306 				 const u8 *peer, u32 num_packets, gfp_t gfp);
7307 
7308 /**
7309  * cfg80211_cqm_txe_notify - TX error rate event
7310  * @dev: network device
7311  * @peer: peer's MAC address
7312  * @num_packets: how many packets were lost
7313  * @rate: % of packets which failed transmission
7314  * @intvl: interval (in s) over which the TX failure threshold was breached.
7315  * @gfp: context flags
7316  *
7317  * Notify userspace when configured % TX failures over number of packets in a
7318  * given interval is exceeded.
7319  */
7320 void cfg80211_cqm_txe_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *peer,
7321 			     u32 num_packets, u32 rate, u32 intvl, gfp_t gfp);
7322 
7323 /**
7324  * cfg80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify - beacon loss event
7325  * @dev: network device
7326  * @gfp: context flags
7327  *
7328  * Notify userspace about beacon loss from the connected AP.
7329  */
7330 void cfg80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify(struct net_device *dev, gfp_t gfp);
7331 
7332 /**
7333  * cfg80211_radar_event - radar detection event
7334  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7335  * @chandef: chandef for the current channel
7336  * @gfp: context flags
7337  *
7338  * This function is called when a radar is detected on the current chanenl.
7339  */
7340 void cfg80211_radar_event(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7341 			  struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, gfp_t gfp);
7342 
7343 /**
7344  * cfg80211_sta_opmode_change_notify - STA's ht/vht operation mode change event
7345  * @dev: network device
7346  * @mac: MAC address of a station which opmode got modified
7347  * @sta_opmode: station's current opmode value
7348  * @gfp: context flags
7349  *
7350  * Driver should call this function when station's opmode modified via action
7351  * frame.
7352  */
7353 void cfg80211_sta_opmode_change_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac,
7354 				       struct sta_opmode_info *sta_opmode,
7355 				       gfp_t gfp);
7356 
7357 /**
7358  * cfg80211_cac_event - Channel availability check (CAC) event
7359  * @netdev: network device
7360  * @chandef: chandef for the current channel
7361  * @event: type of event
7362  * @gfp: context flags
7363  *
7364  * This function is called when a Channel availability check (CAC) is finished
7365  * or aborted. This must be called to notify the completion of a CAC process,
7366  * also by full-MAC drivers.
7367  */
7368 void cfg80211_cac_event(struct net_device *netdev,
7369 			const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
7370 			enum nl80211_radar_event event, gfp_t gfp);
7371 
7372 
7373 /**
7374  * cfg80211_gtk_rekey_notify - notify userspace about driver rekeying
7375  * @dev: network device
7376  * @bssid: BSSID of AP (to avoid races)
7377  * @replay_ctr: new replay counter
7378  * @gfp: allocation flags
7379  */
7380 void cfg80211_gtk_rekey_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
7381 			       const u8 *replay_ctr, gfp_t gfp);
7382 
7383 /**
7384  * cfg80211_pmksa_candidate_notify - notify about PMKSA caching candidate
7385  * @dev: network device
7386  * @index: candidate index (the smaller the index, the higher the priority)
7387  * @bssid: BSSID of AP
7388  * @preauth: Whether AP advertises support for RSN pre-authentication
7389  * @gfp: allocation flags
7390  */
7391 void cfg80211_pmksa_candidate_notify(struct net_device *dev, int index,
7392 				     const u8 *bssid, bool preauth, gfp_t gfp);
7393 
7394 /**
7395  * cfg80211_rx_spurious_frame - inform userspace about a spurious frame
7396  * @dev: The device the frame matched to
7397  * @addr: the transmitter address
7398  * @gfp: context flags
7399  *
7400  * This function is used in AP mode (only!) to inform userspace that
7401  * a spurious class 3 frame was received, to be able to deauth the
7402  * sender.
7403  * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace (or this failed
7404  * for a reason other than not having a subscription.)
7405  */
7406 bool cfg80211_rx_spurious_frame(struct net_device *dev,
7407 				const u8 *addr, gfp_t gfp);
7408 
7409 /**
7410  * cfg80211_rx_unexpected_4addr_frame - inform about unexpected WDS frame
7411  * @dev: The device the frame matched to
7412  * @addr: the transmitter address
7413  * @gfp: context flags
7414  *
7415  * This function is used in AP mode (only!) to inform userspace that
7416  * an associated station sent a 4addr frame but that wasn't expected.
7417  * It is allowed and desirable to send this event only once for each
7418  * station to avoid event flooding.
7419  * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace (or this failed
7420  * for a reason other than not having a subscription.)
7421  */
7422 bool cfg80211_rx_unexpected_4addr_frame(struct net_device *dev,
7423 					const u8 *addr, gfp_t gfp);
7424 
7425 /**
7426  * cfg80211_probe_status - notify userspace about probe status
7427  * @dev: the device the probe was sent on
7428  * @addr: the address of the peer
7429  * @cookie: the cookie filled in @probe_client previously
7430  * @acked: indicates whether probe was acked or not
7431  * @ack_signal: signal strength (in dBm) of the ACK frame.
7432  * @is_valid_ack_signal: indicates the ack_signal is valid or not.
7433  * @gfp: allocation flags
7434  */
7435 void cfg80211_probe_status(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr,
7436 			   u64 cookie, bool acked, s32 ack_signal,
7437 			   bool is_valid_ack_signal, gfp_t gfp);
7438 
7439 /**
7440  * cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz - report beacon from other APs
7441  * @wiphy: The wiphy that received the beacon
7442  * @frame: the frame
7443  * @len: length of the frame
7444  * @freq: frequency the frame was received on in KHz
7445  * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
7446  *
7447  * Use this function to report to userspace when a beacon was
7448  * received. It is not useful to call this when there is no
7449  * netdev that is in AP/GO mode.
7450  */
7451 void cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz(struct wiphy *wiphy, const u8 *frame,
7452 				     size_t len, int freq, int sig_dbm);
7453 
7454 /**
7455  * cfg80211_report_obss_beacon - report beacon from other APs
7456  * @wiphy: The wiphy that received the beacon
7457  * @frame: the frame
7458  * @len: length of the frame
7459  * @freq: frequency the frame was received on
7460  * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
7461  *
7462  * Use this function to report to userspace when a beacon was
7463  * received. It is not useful to call this when there is no
7464  * netdev that is in AP/GO mode.
7465  */
cfg80211_report_obss_beacon(struct wiphy * wiphy,const u8 * frame,size_t len,int freq,int sig_dbm)7466 static inline void cfg80211_report_obss_beacon(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7467 					       const u8 *frame, size_t len,
7468 					       int freq, int sig_dbm)
7469 {
7470 	cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz(wiphy, frame, len, MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq),
7471 					sig_dbm);
7472 }
7473 
7474 /**
7475  * cfg80211_reg_can_beacon - check if beaconing is allowed
7476  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7477  * @chandef: the channel definition
7478  * @iftype: interface type
7479  *
7480  * Return: %true if there is no secondary channel or the secondary channel(s)
7481  * can be used for beaconing (i.e. is not a radar channel etc.)
7482  */
7483 bool cfg80211_reg_can_beacon(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7484 			     struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
7485 			     enum nl80211_iftype iftype);
7486 
7487 /**
7488  * cfg80211_reg_can_beacon_relax - check if beaconing is allowed with relaxation
7489  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7490  * @chandef: the channel definition
7491  * @iftype: interface type
7492  *
7493  * Return: %true if there is no secondary channel or the secondary channel(s)
7494  * can be used for beaconing (i.e. is not a radar channel etc.). This version
7495  * also checks if IR-relaxation conditions apply, to allow beaconing under
7496  * more permissive conditions.
7497  *
7498  * Requires the RTNL to be held.
7499  */
7500 bool cfg80211_reg_can_beacon_relax(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7501 				   struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
7502 				   enum nl80211_iftype iftype);
7503 
7504 /*
7505  * cfg80211_ch_switch_notify - update wdev channel and notify userspace
7506  * @dev: the device which switched channels
7507  * @chandef: the new channel definition
7508  *
7509  * Caller must acquire wdev_lock, therefore must only be called from sleepable
7510  * driver context!
7511  */
7512 void cfg80211_ch_switch_notify(struct net_device *dev,
7513 			       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
7514 
7515 /*
7516  * cfg80211_ch_switch_started_notify - notify channel switch start
7517  * @dev: the device on which the channel switch started
7518  * @chandef: the future channel definition
7519  * @count: the number of TBTTs until the channel switch happens
7520  *
7521  * Inform the userspace about the channel switch that has just
7522  * started, so that it can take appropriate actions (eg. starting
7523  * channel switch on other vifs), if necessary.
7524  */
7525 void cfg80211_ch_switch_started_notify(struct net_device *dev,
7526 				       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
7527 				       u8 count);
7528 
7529 /**
7530  * ieee80211_operating_class_to_band - convert operating class to band
7531  *
7532  * @operating_class: the operating class to convert
7533  * @band: band pointer to fill
7534  *
7535  * Returns %true if the conversion was successful, %false otherwise.
7536  */
7537 bool ieee80211_operating_class_to_band(u8 operating_class,
7538 				       enum nl80211_band *band);
7539 
7540 /**
7541  * ieee80211_chandef_to_operating_class - convert chandef to operation class
7542  *
7543  * @chandef: the chandef to convert
7544  * @op_class: a pointer to the resulting operating class
7545  *
7546  * Returns %true if the conversion was successful, %false otherwise.
7547  */
7548 bool ieee80211_chandef_to_operating_class(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
7549 					  u8 *op_class);
7550 
7551 /**
7552  * ieee80211_chandef_to_khz - convert chandef to frequency in KHz
7553  *
7554  * @chandef: the chandef to convert
7555  *
7556  * Returns the center frequency of chandef (1st segment) in KHz.
7557  */
7558 static inline u32
ieee80211_chandef_to_khz(const struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef)7559 ieee80211_chandef_to_khz(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
7560 {
7561 	return MHZ_TO_KHZ(chandef->center_freq1) + chandef->freq1_offset;
7562 }
7563 
7564 /*
7565  * cfg80211_tdls_oper_request - request userspace to perform TDLS operation
7566  * @dev: the device on which the operation is requested
7567  * @peer: the MAC address of the peer device
7568  * @oper: the requested TDLS operation (NL80211_TDLS_SETUP or
7569  *	NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN)
7570  * @reason_code: the reason code for teardown request
7571  * @gfp: allocation flags
7572  *
7573  * This function is used to request userspace to perform TDLS operation that
7574  * requires knowledge of keys, i.e., link setup or teardown when the AP
7575  * connection uses encryption. This is optional mechanism for the driver to use
7576  * if it can automatically determine when a TDLS link could be useful (e.g.,
7577  * based on traffic and signal strength for a peer).
7578  */
7579 void cfg80211_tdls_oper_request(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *peer,
7580 				enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper,
7581 				u16 reason_code, gfp_t gfp);
7582 
7583 /*
7584  * cfg80211_calculate_bitrate - calculate actual bitrate (in 100Kbps units)
7585  * @rate: given rate_info to calculate bitrate from
7586  *
7587  * return 0 if MCS index >= 32
7588  */
7589 u32 cfg80211_calculate_bitrate(struct rate_info *rate);
7590 
7591 /**
7592  * cfg80211_unregister_wdev - remove the given wdev
7593  * @wdev: struct wireless_dev to remove
7594  *
7595  * Call this function only for wdevs that have no netdev assigned,
7596  * e.g. P2P Devices. It removes the device from the list so that
7597  * it can no longer be used. It is necessary to call this function
7598  * even when cfg80211 requests the removal of the interface by
7599  * calling the del_virtual_intf() callback. The function must also
7600  * be called when the driver wishes to unregister the wdev, e.g.
7601  * when the device is unbound from the driver.
7602  *
7603  * Requires the RTNL to be held.
7604  */
7605 void cfg80211_unregister_wdev(struct wireless_dev *wdev);
7606 
7607 /**
7608  * struct cfg80211_ft_event_params - FT Information Elements
7609  * @ies: FT IEs
7610  * @ies_len: length of the FT IE in bytes
7611  * @target_ap: target AP's MAC address
7612  * @ric_ies: RIC IE
7613  * @ric_ies_len: length of the RIC IE in bytes
7614  */
7615 struct cfg80211_ft_event_params {
7616 	const u8 *ies;
7617 	size_t ies_len;
7618 	const u8 *target_ap;
7619 	const u8 *ric_ies;
7620 	size_t ric_ies_len;
7621 };
7622 
7623 /**
7624  * cfg80211_ft_event - notify userspace about FT IE and RIC IE
7625  * @netdev: network device
7626  * @ft_event: IE information
7627  */
7628 void cfg80211_ft_event(struct net_device *netdev,
7629 		       struct cfg80211_ft_event_params *ft_event);
7630 
7631 /**
7632  * cfg80211_get_p2p_attr - find and copy a P2P attribute from IE buffer
7633  * @ies: the input IE buffer
7634  * @len: the input length
7635  * @attr: the attribute ID to find
7636  * @buf: output buffer, can be %NULL if the data isn't needed, e.g.
7637  *	if the function is only called to get the needed buffer size
7638  * @bufsize: size of the output buffer
7639  *
7640  * The function finds a given P2P attribute in the (vendor) IEs and
7641  * copies its contents to the given buffer.
7642  *
7643  * Return: A negative error code (-%EILSEQ or -%ENOENT) if the data is
7644  * malformed or the attribute can't be found (respectively), or the
7645  * length of the found attribute (which can be zero).
7646  */
7647 int cfg80211_get_p2p_attr(const u8 *ies, unsigned int len,
7648 			  enum ieee80211_p2p_attr_id attr,
7649 			  u8 *buf, unsigned int bufsize);
7650 
7651 /**
7652  * ieee80211_ie_split_ric - split an IE buffer according to ordering (with RIC)
7653  * @ies: the IE buffer
7654  * @ielen: the length of the IE buffer
7655  * @ids: an array with element IDs that are allowed before
7656  *	the split. A WLAN_EID_EXTENSION value means that the next
7657  *	EID in the list is a sub-element of the EXTENSION IE.
7658  * @n_ids: the size of the element ID array
7659  * @after_ric: array IE types that come after the RIC element
7660  * @n_after_ric: size of the @after_ric array
7661  * @offset: offset where to start splitting in the buffer
7662  *
7663  * This function splits an IE buffer by updating the @offset
7664  * variable to point to the location where the buffer should be
7665  * split.
7666  *
7667  * It assumes that the given IE buffer is well-formed, this
7668  * has to be guaranteed by the caller!
7669  *
7670  * It also assumes that the IEs in the buffer are ordered
7671  * correctly, if not the result of using this function will not
7672  * be ordered correctly either, i.e. it does no reordering.
7673  *
7674  * The function returns the offset where the next part of the
7675  * buffer starts, which may be @ielen if the entire (remainder)
7676  * of the buffer should be used.
7677  */
7678 size_t ieee80211_ie_split_ric(const u8 *ies, size_t ielen,
7679 			      const u8 *ids, int n_ids,
7680 			      const u8 *after_ric, int n_after_ric,
7681 			      size_t offset);
7682 
7683 /**
7684  * ieee80211_ie_split - split an IE buffer according to ordering
7685  * @ies: the IE buffer
7686  * @ielen: the length of the IE buffer
7687  * @ids: an array with element IDs that are allowed before
7688  *	the split. A WLAN_EID_EXTENSION value means that the next
7689  *	EID in the list is a sub-element of the EXTENSION IE.
7690  * @n_ids: the size of the element ID array
7691  * @offset: offset where to start splitting in the buffer
7692  *
7693  * This function splits an IE buffer by updating the @offset
7694  * variable to point to the location where the buffer should be
7695  * split.
7696  *
7697  * It assumes that the given IE buffer is well-formed, this
7698  * has to be guaranteed by the caller!
7699  *
7700  * It also assumes that the IEs in the buffer are ordered
7701  * correctly, if not the result of using this function will not
7702  * be ordered correctly either, i.e. it does no reordering.
7703  *
7704  * The function returns the offset where the next part of the
7705  * buffer starts, which may be @ielen if the entire (remainder)
7706  * of the buffer should be used.
7707  */
ieee80211_ie_split(const u8 * ies,size_t ielen,const u8 * ids,int n_ids,size_t offset)7708 static inline size_t ieee80211_ie_split(const u8 *ies, size_t ielen,
7709 					const u8 *ids, int n_ids, size_t offset)
7710 {
7711 	return ieee80211_ie_split_ric(ies, ielen, ids, n_ids, NULL, 0, offset);
7712 }
7713 
7714 /**
7715  * cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup - report wakeup from WoWLAN
7716  * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the wakeup
7717  * @wakeup: the wakeup report
7718  * @gfp: allocation flags
7719  *
7720  * This function reports that the given device woke up. If it
7721  * caused the wakeup, report the reason(s), otherwise you may
7722  * pass %NULL as the @wakeup parameter to advertise that something
7723  * else caused the wakeup.
7724  */
7725 void cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
7726 				   struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup *wakeup,
7727 				   gfp_t gfp);
7728 
7729 /**
7730  * cfg80211_crit_proto_stopped() - indicate critical protocol stopped by driver.
7731  *
7732  * @wdev: the wireless device for which critical protocol is stopped.
7733  * @gfp: allocation flags
7734  *
7735  * This function can be called by the driver to indicate it has reverted
7736  * operation back to normal. One reason could be that the duration given
7737  * by .crit_proto_start() has expired.
7738  */
7739 void cfg80211_crit_proto_stopped(struct wireless_dev *wdev, gfp_t gfp);
7740 
7741 /**
7742  * ieee80211_get_num_supported_channels - get number of channels device has
7743  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7744  *
7745  * Return: the number of channels supported by the device.
7746  */
7747 unsigned int ieee80211_get_num_supported_channels(struct wiphy *wiphy);
7748 
7749 /**
7750  * cfg80211_check_combinations - check interface combinations
7751  *
7752  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7753  * @params: the interface combinations parameter
7754  *
7755  * This function can be called by the driver to check whether a
7756  * combination of interfaces and their types are allowed according to
7757  * the interface combinations.
7758  */
7759 int cfg80211_check_combinations(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7760 				struct iface_combination_params *params);
7761 
7762 /**
7763  * cfg80211_iter_combinations - iterate over matching combinations
7764  *
7765  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7766  * @params: the interface combinations parameter
7767  * @iter: function to call for each matching combination
7768  * @data: pointer to pass to iter function
7769  *
7770  * This function can be called by the driver to check what possible
7771  * combinations it fits in at a given moment, e.g. for channel switching
7772  * purposes.
7773  */
7774 int cfg80211_iter_combinations(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7775 			       struct iface_combination_params *params,
7776 			       void (*iter)(const struct ieee80211_iface_combination *c,
7777 					    void *data),
7778 			       void *data);
7779 
7780 /*
7781  * cfg80211_stop_iface - trigger interface disconnection
7782  *
7783  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7784  * @wdev: wireless device
7785  * @gfp: context flags
7786  *
7787  * Trigger interface to be stopped as if AP was stopped, IBSS/mesh left, STA
7788  * disconnected.
7789  *
7790  * Note: This doesn't need any locks and is asynchronous.
7791  */
7792 void cfg80211_stop_iface(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
7793 			 gfp_t gfp);
7794 
7795 /**
7796  * cfg80211_shutdown_all_interfaces - shut down all interfaces for a wiphy
7797  * @wiphy: the wiphy to shut down
7798  *
7799  * This function shuts down all interfaces belonging to this wiphy by
7800  * calling dev_close() (and treating non-netdev interfaces as needed).
7801  * It shouldn't really be used unless there are some fatal device errors
7802  * that really can't be recovered in any other way.
7803  *
7804  * Callers must hold the RTNL and be able to deal with callbacks into
7805  * the driver while the function is running.
7806  */
7807 void cfg80211_shutdown_all_interfaces(struct wiphy *wiphy);
7808 
7809 /**
7810  * wiphy_ext_feature_set - set the extended feature flag
7811  *
7812  * @wiphy: the wiphy to modify.
7813  * @ftidx: extended feature bit index.
7814  *
7815  * The extended features are flagged in multiple bytes (see
7816  * &struct wiphy.@ext_features)
7817  */
wiphy_ext_feature_set(struct wiphy * wiphy,enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx)7818 static inline void wiphy_ext_feature_set(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7819 					 enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx)
7820 {
7821 	u8 *ft_byte;
7822 
7823 	ft_byte = &wiphy->ext_features[ftidx / 8];
7824 	*ft_byte |= BIT(ftidx % 8);
7825 }
7826 
7827 /**
7828  * wiphy_ext_feature_isset - check the extended feature flag
7829  *
7830  * @wiphy: the wiphy to modify.
7831  * @ftidx: extended feature bit index.
7832  *
7833  * The extended features are flagged in multiple bytes (see
7834  * &struct wiphy.@ext_features)
7835  */
7836 static inline bool
wiphy_ext_feature_isset(struct wiphy * wiphy,enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx)7837 wiphy_ext_feature_isset(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7838 			enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx)
7839 {
7840 	u8 ft_byte;
7841 
7842 	ft_byte = wiphy->ext_features[ftidx / 8];
7843 	return (ft_byte & BIT(ftidx % 8)) != 0;
7844 }
7845 
7846 /**
7847  * cfg80211_free_nan_func - free NAN function
7848  * @f: NAN function that should be freed
7849  *
7850  * Frees all the NAN function and all it's allocated members.
7851  */
7852 void cfg80211_free_nan_func(struct cfg80211_nan_func *f);
7853 
7854 /**
7855  * struct cfg80211_nan_match_params - NAN match parameters
7856  * @type: the type of the function that triggered a match. If it is
7857  *	 %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE it means that we replied to a subscriber.
7858  *	 If it is %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH, it means that we got a discovery
7859  *	 result.
7860  *	 If it is %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP, we received a follow up.
7861  * @inst_id: the local instance id
7862  * @peer_inst_id: the instance id of the peer's function
7863  * @addr: the MAC address of the peer
7864  * @info_len: the length of the &info
7865  * @info: the Service Specific Info from the peer (if any)
7866  * @cookie: unique identifier of the corresponding function
7867  */
7868 struct cfg80211_nan_match_params {
7869 	enum nl80211_nan_function_type type;
7870 	u8 inst_id;
7871 	u8 peer_inst_id;
7872 	const u8 *addr;
7873 	u8 info_len;
7874 	const u8 *info;
7875 	u64 cookie;
7876 };
7877 
7878 /**
7879  * cfg80211_nan_match - report a match for a NAN function.
7880  * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the match
7881  * @match: match notification parameters
7882  * @gfp: allocation flags
7883  *
7884  * This function reports that the a NAN function had a match. This
7885  * can be a subscribe that had a match or a solicited publish that
7886  * was sent. It can also be a follow up that was received.
7887  */
7888 void cfg80211_nan_match(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
7889 			struct cfg80211_nan_match_params *match, gfp_t gfp);
7890 
7891 /**
7892  * cfg80211_nan_func_terminated - notify about NAN function termination.
7893  *
7894  * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the match
7895  * @inst_id: the local instance id
7896  * @reason: termination reason (one of the NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_*)
7897  * @cookie: unique NAN function identifier
7898  * @gfp: allocation flags
7899  *
7900  * This function reports that the a NAN function is terminated.
7901  */
7902 void cfg80211_nan_func_terminated(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
7903 				  u8 inst_id,
7904 				  enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason reason,
7905 				  u64 cookie, gfp_t gfp);
7906 
7907 /* ethtool helper */
7908 void cfg80211_get_drvinfo(struct net_device *dev, struct ethtool_drvinfo *info);
7909 
7910 /**
7911  * cfg80211_external_auth_request - userspace request for authentication
7912  * @netdev: network device
7913  * @params: External authentication parameters
7914  * @gfp: allocation flags
7915  * Returns: 0 on success, < 0 on error
7916  */
7917 int cfg80211_external_auth_request(struct net_device *netdev,
7918 				   struct cfg80211_external_auth_params *params,
7919 				   gfp_t gfp);
7920 
7921 /**
7922  * cfg80211_pmsr_report - report peer measurement result data
7923  * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the measurement
7924  * @req: the original measurement request
7925  * @result: the result data
7926  * @gfp: allocation flags
7927  */
7928 void cfg80211_pmsr_report(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
7929 			  struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *req,
7930 			  struct cfg80211_pmsr_result *result,
7931 			  gfp_t gfp);
7932 
7933 /**
7934  * cfg80211_pmsr_complete - report peer measurement completed
7935  * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the measurement
7936  * @req: the original measurement request
7937  * @gfp: allocation flags
7938  *
7939  * Report that the entire measurement completed, after this
7940  * the request pointer will no longer be valid.
7941  */
7942 void cfg80211_pmsr_complete(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
7943 			    struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *req,
7944 			    gfp_t gfp);
7945 
7946 /**
7947  * cfg80211_iftype_allowed - check whether the interface can be allowed
7948  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7949  * @iftype: interface type
7950  * @is_4addr: use_4addr flag, must be '0' when check_swif is '1'
7951  * @check_swif: check iftype against software interfaces
7952  *
7953  * Check whether the interface is allowed to operate; additionally, this API
7954  * can be used to check iftype against the software interfaces when
7955  * check_swif is '1'.
7956  */
7957 bool cfg80211_iftype_allowed(struct wiphy *wiphy, enum nl80211_iftype iftype,
7958 			     bool is_4addr, u8 check_swif);
7959 
7960 
7961 /* Logging, debugging and troubleshooting/diagnostic helpers. */
7962 
7963 /* wiphy_printk helpers, similar to dev_printk */
7964 
7965 #define wiphy_printk(level, wiphy, format, args...)		\
7966 	dev_printk(level, &(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
7967 #define wiphy_emerg(wiphy, format, args...)			\
7968 	dev_emerg(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
7969 #define wiphy_alert(wiphy, format, args...)			\
7970 	dev_alert(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
7971 #define wiphy_crit(wiphy, format, args...)			\
7972 	dev_crit(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
7973 #define wiphy_err(wiphy, format, args...)			\
7974 	dev_err(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
7975 #define wiphy_warn(wiphy, format, args...)			\
7976 	dev_warn(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
7977 #define wiphy_notice(wiphy, format, args...)			\
7978 	dev_notice(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
7979 #define wiphy_info(wiphy, format, args...)			\
7980 	dev_info(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
7981 
7982 #define wiphy_err_ratelimited(wiphy, format, args...)		\
7983 	dev_err_ratelimited(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
7984 #define wiphy_warn_ratelimited(wiphy, format, args...)		\
7985 	dev_warn_ratelimited(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
7986 
7987 #define wiphy_debug(wiphy, format, args...)			\
7988 	wiphy_printk(KERN_DEBUG, wiphy, format, ##args)
7989 
7990 #define wiphy_dbg(wiphy, format, args...)			\
7991 	dev_dbg(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
7992 
7993 #if defined(VERBOSE_DEBUG)
7994 #define wiphy_vdbg	wiphy_dbg
7995 #else
7996 #define wiphy_vdbg(wiphy, format, args...)				\
7997 ({									\
7998 	if (0)								\
7999 		wiphy_printk(KERN_DEBUG, wiphy, format, ##args);	\
8000 	0;								\
8001 })
8002 #endif
8003 
8004 /*
8005  * wiphy_WARN() acts like wiphy_printk(), but with the key difference
8006  * of using a WARN/WARN_ON to get the message out, including the
8007  * file/line information and a backtrace.
8008  */
8009 #define wiphy_WARN(wiphy, format, args...)			\
8010 	WARN(1, "wiphy: %s\n" format, wiphy_name(wiphy), ##args);
8011 
8012 /**
8013  * cfg80211_update_owe_info_event - Notify the peer's OWE info to user space
8014  * @netdev: network device
8015  * @owe_info: peer's owe info
8016  * @gfp: allocation flags
8017  */
8018 void cfg80211_update_owe_info_event(struct net_device *netdev,
8019 				    struct cfg80211_update_owe_info *owe_info,
8020 				    gfp_t gfp);
8021 
8022 /**
8023  * cfg80211_bss_flush - resets all the scan entries
8024  * @wiphy: the wiphy
8025  */
8026 void cfg80211_bss_flush(struct wiphy *wiphy);
8027 
8028 #endif /* __NET_CFG80211_H */
8029